1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing. Remember that
45 . the <bookinfo> element must also be updated for each new edition.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.80"
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
55 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
56 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
57 . provided in the xfpt library.
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
60 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
62 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
64 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
65 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
67 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
68 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
70 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
71 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
72 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
82 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
83 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
88 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
89 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
91 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
92 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
95 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
96 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
97 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
113 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
114 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
115 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
116 . --- ID that ties them together.
119 &<indexterm role="concept">&
120 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
122 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
128 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
129 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
131 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
137 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 &<indexterm role="option">&
142 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
144 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
150 &<indexterm role="variable">&
151 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
153 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
159 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
161 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
172 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
173 <date>17 May 2012</date>
174 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
175 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
176 <revhistory><revision>
177 <revnumber>4.80</revnumber>
178 <date>17 May 2012</date>
179 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
180 </revision></revhistory>
181 <copyright><year>2012</year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
186 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
187 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
188 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
189 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
190 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
192 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
195 <indexterm role="variable">
196 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
197 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
199 <indexterm role="concept">
200 <primary>address</primary>
201 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
202 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
204 <indexterm role="concept">
205 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
206 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
208 <indexterm role="concept">
209 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
210 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
212 <indexterm role="concept">
213 <primary>CR character</primary>
214 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
216 <indexterm role="concept">
217 <primary>CRL</primary>
218 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
220 <indexterm role="concept">
221 <primary>delivery</primary>
222 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
223 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
225 <indexterm role="concept">
226 <primary>dialup</primary>
227 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
229 <indexterm role="concept">
230 <primary>exiscan</primary>
231 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
233 <indexterm role="concept">
234 <primary>failover</primary>
235 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
237 <indexterm role="concept">
238 <primary>fallover</primary>
239 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
241 <indexterm role="concept">
242 <primary>filter</primary>
243 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
244 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
246 <indexterm role="concept">
247 <primary>ident</primary>
248 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
250 <indexterm role="concept">
251 <primary>LF character</primary>
252 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
254 <indexterm role="concept">
255 <primary>maximum</primary>
256 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
258 <indexterm role="concept">
259 <primary>monitor</primary>
260 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
262 <indexterm role="concept">
263 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
264 <see>entry for xxx</see>
266 <indexterm role="concept">
267 <primary>NUL</primary>
268 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
270 <indexterm role="concept">
271 <primary>passwd file</primary>
272 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
274 <indexterm role="concept">
275 <primary>process id</primary>
276 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
278 <indexterm role="concept">
279 <primary>RBL</primary>
280 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
282 <indexterm role="concept">
283 <primary>redirection</primary>
284 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
286 <indexterm role="concept">
287 <primary>return path</primary>
288 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
290 <indexterm role="concept">
291 <primary>scanning</primary>
292 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
294 <indexterm role="concept">
295 <primary>SSL</primary>
296 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
298 <indexterm role="concept">
299 <primary>string</primary>
300 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
301 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
303 <indexterm role="concept">
304 <primary>top bit</primary>
305 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
307 <indexterm role="concept">
308 <primary>variables</primary>
309 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
311 <indexterm role="concept">
312 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
313 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
319 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
320 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
321 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
322 . chapter "Introduction"
323 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
325 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
326 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
327 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
328 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
330 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
331 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
332 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
333 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
334 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
335 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
336 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
338 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
339 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
340 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
342 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
343 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
344 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
346 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
347 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
348 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
349 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
350 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
352 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
353 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
354 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
355 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
356 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
358 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
359 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
360 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
361 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
365 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
366 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
369 .cindex "documentation"
370 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version; of Exim.
371 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
372 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
373 capable of showing a change indicator.
376 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
377 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
378 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
379 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
380 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
381 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
382 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
385 .cindex "books about Exim"
386 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
387 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
388 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
389 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
391 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
392 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
393 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
394 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
396 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
397 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
398 Debian-specific features in the file
399 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
400 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
403 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
404 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
406 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
407 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
408 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
409 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
410 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
412 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
413 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
414 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
415 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
417 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
418 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
420 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
421 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
422 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
426 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
427 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
428 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
429 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
430 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
431 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
432 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
435 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
436 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
437 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
441 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
444 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
445 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
446 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
447 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
448 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
449 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
453 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
454 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
455 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
456 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
457 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
460 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
461 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
462 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
466 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
467 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
468 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
471 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
472 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
473 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
474 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
477 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
478 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
479 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
480 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
481 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
484 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
486 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
489 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
490 .cindex "training courses"
491 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
492 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
493 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
494 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
496 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
497 .cindex "bug reports"
498 .cindex "reporting bugs"
499 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
500 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
501 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
502 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
506 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
508 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
509 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
511 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
515 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
517 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
518 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
519 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
521 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
522 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
523 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
524 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
527 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
529 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
530 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
531 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
533 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
534 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
535 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
536 The distributions are currently signed with Nigel Metheringham's GPG key. The
537 corresponding public key is available from a number of keyservers, and there is
538 also a copy in the file &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. The signatures for the tar bundles are
541 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
542 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
544 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
545 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
546 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
548 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
549 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
550 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
551 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
553 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
554 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
555 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
556 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
558 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
559 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
562 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
564 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
565 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
566 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
567 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
568 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
569 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
570 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
572 .cindex "domainless addresses"
573 .cindex "address" "without domain"
574 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
575 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
576 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
577 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
580 .cindex "transport" "external"
581 .cindex "external transports"
582 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
583 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
584 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
585 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
586 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
587 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
589 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
590 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
591 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
594 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
595 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
596 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
597 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
598 a number of common scanners are provided.
602 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
603 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
604 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
605 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
606 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
607 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
610 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
611 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
612 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
613 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
614 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
615 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
616 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
617 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
618 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
619 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
620 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
621 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
623 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
624 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
625 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
626 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
630 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
631 .cindex "terminology definitions"
632 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
633 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
634 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
635 below) by a blank line.
637 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
638 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
639 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
640 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
641 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
642 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
643 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
644 rise to further bounce messages.
646 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
647 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
648 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
651 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
652 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
653 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
656 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
657 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
658 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
660 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
661 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
662 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
663 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
664 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
665 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
666 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
667 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
669 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
670 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
671 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
672 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
673 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
674 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
677 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
678 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
679 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
680 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
681 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
683 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
684 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
685 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
686 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
687 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
688 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
690 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
691 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
694 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
695 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
696 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
697 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
698 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
700 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
701 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
702 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
703 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
704 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
706 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
707 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
708 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
709 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
710 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
711 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
718 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
719 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
721 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
722 .cindex "incorporated code"
723 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
725 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
728 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
729 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
730 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
731 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
732 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
733 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
735 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
736 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
737 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
738 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
739 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
740 following statements:
743 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
745 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
746 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
747 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
749 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
750 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
751 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
752 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
753 restrictions applied to it).
756 .cindex "SPA authentication"
757 .cindex "Samba project"
758 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
759 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
760 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
761 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
765 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
766 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
767 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
768 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
769 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
770 conditions expressed therein.
773 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
775 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
776 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
780 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
781 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
783 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
784 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
785 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
788 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
789 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
790 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
791 details, please contact
793 Office of Technology Transfer
794 Carnegie Mellon University
796 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
797 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
798 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
801 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
804 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
805 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
807 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
808 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
809 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
810 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
811 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
812 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
813 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
818 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
821 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
822 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
823 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
824 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
827 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
828 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
832 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
833 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
834 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
835 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
836 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
837 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
838 software without specific, written prior permission.
840 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
841 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
842 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
843 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
844 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
845 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
850 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
851 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
852 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
859 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
860 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
862 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
863 "Receiving and delivering mail"
866 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
867 .cindex "design philosophy"
868 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
869 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
870 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
871 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
872 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
873 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
876 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
877 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
878 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
879 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
880 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
881 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
882 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
885 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
886 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
887 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
888 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
889 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
890 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
891 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
892 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
893 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
896 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
897 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
899 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
900 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
901 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
902 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
904 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
905 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
906 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
907 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
908 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
910 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
911 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
912 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
914 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
915 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
916 runs at the start of every delivery process.
921 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
922 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
923 .cindex "Sieve filter"
924 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
925 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
926 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
927 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
928 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
929 of filtering are available:
932 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
935 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
936 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
939 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
943 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
944 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
945 .cindex "format" "of message id"
946 .cindex "id of message"
951 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
952 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
953 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
954 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
955 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
956 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
957 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
958 not always case-sensitive.
960 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
961 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
962 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
963 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
964 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
965 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
969 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
970 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
971 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
972 way of representing the date and time of day).
974 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
975 received the message.
977 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
979 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
980 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
981 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
982 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
983 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
985 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
986 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
991 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
992 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
993 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
994 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
995 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
998 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
999 .cindex "receiving mail"
1000 .cindex "message" "reception"
1001 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1002 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1003 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1004 there are several possibilities:
1007 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1008 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1009 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1011 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1012 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1013 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1014 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1015 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1016 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1018 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1019 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1020 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1021 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1022 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1024 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1025 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1026 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1027 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1031 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1032 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1033 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1034 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1035 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1036 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1037 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1038 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1039 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1040 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1041 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1042 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1043 users to change sender addresses.
1045 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1046 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1047 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1048 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1049 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1050 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1051 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1053 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1054 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1055 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1056 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1057 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1058 message is received.
1064 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1065 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1066 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1067 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1068 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1069 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1070 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1071 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1073 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1074 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1075 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1076 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1077 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1078 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1079 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1080 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1081 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1082 affect file system performance.
1084 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1085 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1086 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1087 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1088 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1090 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1091 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1092 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1093 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1094 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1095 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1096 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1097 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1098 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1099 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1100 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1101 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1105 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1106 .cindex "message" "life of"
1107 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1108 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1109 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1110 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1111 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1112 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1113 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1115 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1116 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1117 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1118 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1119 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1122 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1123 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1124 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1125 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1126 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1128 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1129 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1130 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1131 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1132 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1133 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1134 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1135 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1136 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1137 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1140 .cindex "journal file"
1141 .cindex "file" "journal"
1142 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1143 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1144 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1145 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1146 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1147 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1148 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1149 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1151 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1152 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1153 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1154 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1155 deliveries caused by crashes.
1159 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1160 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1161 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1162 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1163 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1164 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1165 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1166 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1167 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1169 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1170 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1171 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1172 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1173 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1174 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1175 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1176 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1177 the driver's features in general.
1179 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1180 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1181 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1182 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1185 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1186 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1187 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1188 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1189 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1190 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1192 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1193 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1194 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1195 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1196 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1197 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1199 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1200 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1201 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1204 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1205 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1206 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1207 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1208 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1209 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1210 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1211 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1212 configured to fail the address.
1214 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1215 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1216 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1217 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1218 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1219 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1221 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1222 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1223 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1224 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1225 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1226 the address is bounced.
1230 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1231 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1232 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1233 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1234 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1235 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1236 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1237 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1239 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1240 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1241 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1242 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1243 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1244 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1245 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1246 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1251 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1252 .cindex "router" "running details"
1253 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1254 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1255 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1256 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1257 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1258 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1262 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1263 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1264 original address ceases,
1265 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1266 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1267 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1268 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1269 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1272 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1273 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1274 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1275 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1276 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1278 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1279 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1280 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1281 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1282 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1284 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1285 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1286 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1287 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1288 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1290 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1291 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1292 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1294 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1295 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1296 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1297 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1299 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1300 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1303 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1304 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1305 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1306 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1307 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1309 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1310 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1311 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1312 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1313 facility for this purpose.
1316 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1317 .cindex "case of local parts"
1318 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1319 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1320 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1321 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1322 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1323 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1324 routed addresses are shown.
1328 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1329 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1330 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1331 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1332 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1333 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1336 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1337 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1338 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1339 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1340 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1341 of any other conditions.
1343 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1344 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1345 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1347 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1348 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1349 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1350 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1352 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1353 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1354 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1355 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1356 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1358 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1359 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1361 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1362 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1364 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1365 of domains that it defines.
1367 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1368 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1369 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1370 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1371 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1372 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1373 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1374 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1375 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1376 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1378 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1379 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1381 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1382 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1383 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1384 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1385 remaining preconditions.
1387 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1388 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1389 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1390 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1391 could lead to confusion.
1393 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1394 set of addresses that it defines.
1396 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1397 specified files is tested.
1399 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1400 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1401 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1402 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1406 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1407 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1408 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1409 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1410 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1411 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1412 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1416 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1417 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1418 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1421 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1422 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1423 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1424 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1425 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1427 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1428 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1430 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1431 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1432 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1433 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1434 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1435 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1438 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1439 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1440 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1441 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1442 processed entirely independently of each other.
1444 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1445 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1446 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1447 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1448 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1449 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1450 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1451 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1452 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1454 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1455 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1456 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1457 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1458 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1459 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1460 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1461 addresses to the same domain.
1463 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1464 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1465 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1466 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1467 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1468 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1469 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1470 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1472 .cindex "queue runner"
1473 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1474 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1475 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1476 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1477 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1478 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1479 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1480 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1481 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1483 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1484 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1485 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1486 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1487 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1488 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1490 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1491 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1492 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1493 messages to other addresses.
1495 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1496 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1497 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1500 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1501 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1502 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1508 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1509 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1510 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1511 .cindex "queue runner"
1512 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1513 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1514 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1515 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1516 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1517 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1518 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1519 passed its retry time.
1520 You can run several queue runners at once.
1522 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1523 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1524 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1525 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1526 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1531 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1532 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1533 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1534 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1535 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1536 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1537 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1538 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1539 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1542 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1543 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1544 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1546 .cindex "hints database"
1547 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1548 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1549 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1550 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1555 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1556 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1557 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1558 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1559 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1560 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1561 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1562 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1563 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1564 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1565 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1567 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1568 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1569 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1572 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1573 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1574 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1575 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1576 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1577 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1578 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1583 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1584 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1585 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1586 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1587 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1588 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1589 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1590 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1596 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1597 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1599 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1600 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1602 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1603 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1604 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1605 &_exim-&version;_&) into which the following files are placed:
1608 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1609 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1611 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1612 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1613 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1614 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1618 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1619 following subdirectories are created:
1622 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1623 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1624 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1625 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1626 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1627 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1628 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1631 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1632 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1633 that may be useful to some sites.
1636 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1637 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1638 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1639 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1640 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1641 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1643 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1644 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1645 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1646 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1647 overridden if necessary.
1650 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1651 .cindex "PCRE library"
1652 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1653 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1654 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1655 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1656 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1657 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1658 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1659 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1660 If your operating system has no
1661 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1662 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1663 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1665 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1666 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1667 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1668 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1669 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1670 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1671 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1673 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1674 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1675 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1676 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1677 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1678 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1679 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1680 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1682 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1683 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1684 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1685 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1686 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1687 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1688 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1689 Berkeley DB library.
1691 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1692 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1696 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1697 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1699 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1700 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1701 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1702 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1703 file name is used unmodified.
1705 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1706 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1707 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1708 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1710 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1711 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1712 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1714 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1715 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1716 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1717 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1718 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1719 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1721 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1722 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1723 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1724 operates on a single file.
1728 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1729 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1730 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1731 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1732 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1736 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1737 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1739 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1740 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1741 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1742 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1743 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1744 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1746 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1747 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1748 in one of these lines:
1753 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1754 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1755 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1756 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1759 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1760 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1762 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1763 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1767 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1768 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1769 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1770 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1771 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1772 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1773 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1774 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1775 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1776 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1777 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1778 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1780 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1781 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1782 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1783 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1784 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1785 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1787 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1788 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1789 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1790 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1791 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1792 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1795 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1796 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1797 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1798 facilities, you need to set
1800 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1802 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1803 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1806 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1807 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1808 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1809 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1810 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1811 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1812 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1814 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1815 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1816 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1817 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1818 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1823 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1824 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1826 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1827 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1828 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1829 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1830 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1831 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1832 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1834 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1835 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1836 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1837 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1838 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1842 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1846 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1847 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1848 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1849 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1850 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1851 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1852 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1853 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1854 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1855 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1858 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1859 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1862 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1865 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1867 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1868 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1871 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1872 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1874 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1875 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1878 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1880 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1881 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1885 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1887 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1888 library and include files. For example:
1892 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1893 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1895 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1896 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1900 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1903 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1904 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1905 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1910 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1912 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1913 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1914 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1915 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1916 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1917 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1918 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1919 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1920 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1921 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1922 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1923 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1926 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1927 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1928 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1930 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1931 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1933 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1935 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1936 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1937 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1938 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1939 in &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1940 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1944 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1945 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1946 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1947 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1948 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1949 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1952 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1953 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1954 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1955 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1956 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. It is not known
1957 if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
1958 this is included only if you set &`SUPPORT_A6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
1959 support has not been tested for some time.
1963 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1964 .cindex "lookup modules"
1965 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1966 .cindex ".so building"
1967 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
1968 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
1970 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
1971 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
1973 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
1975 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
1976 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
1977 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
1978 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
1979 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
1980 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
1982 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
1983 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
1984 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
1993 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
1994 .cindex "build directory"
1995 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
1996 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
1997 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
1998 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
1999 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2000 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2001 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2003 &*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
2004 building process fails if it is set.
2006 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2007 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2008 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2009 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2010 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2011 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2012 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2013 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2015 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2016 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2017 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2021 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2022 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2023 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2024 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2025 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2026 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2027 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2031 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2032 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2033 given in addition to the short output.
2037 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2038 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2039 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2040 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2041 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2042 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2043 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2046 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2047 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2049 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2050 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2051 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2052 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2054 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2055 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2056 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2057 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2058 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2059 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2060 and are often not needed.
2062 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2063 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2064 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2065 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2066 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2067 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2068 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2069 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2070 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2073 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2074 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2075 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2076 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2080 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2081 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2082 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2083 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2084 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2085 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2086 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2087 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2088 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2089 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2090 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2091 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2092 containing the lines
2097 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2098 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2100 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2101 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2102 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2105 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2106 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2107 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2108 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2109 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2110 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2111 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2112 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2113 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2114 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2120 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2121 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2122 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2123 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2124 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2125 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2126 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2127 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2130 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2131 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2132 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2133 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2134 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2135 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2136 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2137 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2138 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2139 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2140 syntax. For instance:
2143 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2145 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2146 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2147 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2150 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2151 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2152 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2156 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2157 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2159 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2160 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2161 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2162 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2163 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2164 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2167 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2168 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2170 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2171 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2174 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2175 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2177 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2178 definition of all three of these variables into your
2179 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2182 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2183 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2184 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2185 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2187 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2188 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2189 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2190 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2191 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2194 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2195 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2196 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2197 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2198 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2201 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2203 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2204 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2205 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2206 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2207 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2208 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2212 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2213 .cindex "building Eximon"
2214 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2215 where the files that are involved are
2217 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2218 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2219 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2220 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2221 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2222 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2224 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2225 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2226 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2227 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2228 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2229 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2230 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2234 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2235 .cindex "installing Exim"
2236 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2237 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2238 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2239 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2240 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2241 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2242 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2243 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2244 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2245 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2246 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2247 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2249 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2250 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2251 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2252 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2253 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2254 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2255 alternative files, no default is installed.
2257 .cindex "system aliases file"
2258 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2259 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2260 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2261 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2262 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2263 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2264 and outputs a comment to the user.
2266 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2267 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2268 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2269 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2270 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2272 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2273 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2274 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2275 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2276 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2279 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2280 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2283 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2285 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2286 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2287 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2288 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2289 but this usage is deprecated.
2291 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2292 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2293 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2294 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2295 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2296 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2298 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2299 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2300 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2301 for example &_exim-&version;-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2302 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2303 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2304 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2306 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2307 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2308 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2311 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2313 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2314 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2315 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2316 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2319 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2321 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2322 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2325 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2326 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2328 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2332 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2334 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2336 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2337 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2338 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2340 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2345 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2346 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2347 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2348 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2349 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2352 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2353 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2354 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2358 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2359 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2360 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2361 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2362 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2368 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2369 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2370 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2371 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2372 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2376 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2377 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2378 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2379 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2380 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2383 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2385 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2387 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2389 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2390 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2391 user agent. For example:
2393 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2394 From: user@your.domain.example
2395 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2396 Subject: Testing Exim
2398 This is a test message.
2401 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2402 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2403 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2405 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2406 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2407 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2408 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2409 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2410 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2412 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2414 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2415 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2416 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2417 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2418 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2420 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2421 .cindex "lock files"
2422 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2423 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2424 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2425 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2426 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2427 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2428 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2429 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2430 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2431 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2432 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2433 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2435 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2436 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2437 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2438 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2439 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2442 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2443 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2444 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2445 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2449 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2450 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2451 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2452 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2453 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2454 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2455 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2456 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2457 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2458 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2459 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2460 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2461 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2463 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2464 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2465 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2466 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2467 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2468 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2471 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2472 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2473 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2474 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2476 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2477 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2478 favourite user agent.
2480 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2481 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2482 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2483 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2484 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2485 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2489 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2490 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2491 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2492 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2493 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2494 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2495 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2496 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2502 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2503 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2504 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2506 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2508 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2509 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2510 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2511 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2512 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2514 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2516 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2518 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2519 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2520 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2525 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2526 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2528 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2529 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2530 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2531 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2532 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2533 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2534 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2535 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2536 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2539 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2541 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2542 were present before any other options.
2543 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2545 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2546 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2547 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2550 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2551 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2552 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2556 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2557 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2558 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2561 .cindex "queue runner"
2562 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2563 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2564 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2566 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2567 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2568 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2569 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2570 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2571 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2572 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2573 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2576 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2577 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2578 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2579 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2580 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2581 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2584 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2585 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2586 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2587 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2588 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2589 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2591 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2592 .cindex "envelope sender"
2593 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2594 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2595 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2596 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2597 users to set envelope senders.
2599 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2600 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2601 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2602 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2603 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2605 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2606 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2607 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2608 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2609 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2610 that are available to trusted users.
2612 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2613 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2614 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2615 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2616 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2618 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2619 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2620 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2621 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2623 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2624 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2625 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2626 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2628 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2629 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2634 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2635 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2636 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2642 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2643 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2644 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2645 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2646 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2647 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2648 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2649 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2651 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2652 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2653 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2654 . creates a man page for the options.
2655 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2658 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2665 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2666 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2667 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2668 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2671 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2672 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2673 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2676 .vitem &%--version%&
2677 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2678 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2686 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2690 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2692 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2693 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2694 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2695 clean; it ignores this option.
2700 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2701 .cindex "queue runner"
2702 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2703 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2704 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2706 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2707 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2708 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2709 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2711 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2712 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2713 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2714 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2716 When a listening daemon
2717 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2718 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2719 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2720 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2721 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2722 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2725 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2726 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2727 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2731 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2732 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2733 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2734 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2735 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2736 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2737 because these are reread each time they are used.
2741 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2742 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2746 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2747 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2748 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2749 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2750 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2751 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2753 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2754 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2755 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2756 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2757 test data. A line history is supported.
2759 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2760 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2761 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2762 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2763 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2764 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2765 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2767 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2768 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2769 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2770 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2772 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2774 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2775 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2776 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2777 of a file. For example:
2779 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2781 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2782 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2783 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2784 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2785 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2786 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2787 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2790 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2792 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2793 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2794 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2795 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2796 system filters are recognized.
2798 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2800 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2801 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2802 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2803 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2804 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2805 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2806 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2807 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2810 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2811 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2812 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2814 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2816 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2817 variables that are used by the user filter.
2819 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2824 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2825 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2826 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2829 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2830 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2831 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2832 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2834 When testing a filter file,
2835 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2836 .cindex "envelope sender"
2837 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2838 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2839 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2840 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2841 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2844 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2846 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2847 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2848 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2851 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2853 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2854 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2855 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2856 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2857 actually being delivered.
2859 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2861 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2862 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2865 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2867 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2868 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2871 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2873 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2874 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2875 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2876 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2877 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2878 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2879 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2880 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2881 after a full stop. For example:
2883 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2884 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2886 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2887 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2888 conversion to the canonical form is
2889 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2891 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2892 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2893 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2894 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2895 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2899 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2900 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2901 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2904 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2905 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2906 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2908 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2909 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2910 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2911 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2912 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2913 session were authenticated.
2915 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2916 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2917 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2919 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2920 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2921 specialized SMTP test program such as
2922 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2924 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2926 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2927 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2928 updating the callout cache database.
2932 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2933 .cindex "building alias file"
2934 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2935 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2936 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2937 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2938 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2941 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2942 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2943 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2944 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2945 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2946 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2950 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2952 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2953 .cindex "querying exim information"
2954 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2955 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2956 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2957 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2958 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2961 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2962 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2963 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2964 recognised DSCP names.
2966 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2967 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2968 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2969 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2970 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
2971 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
2972 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
2973 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
2974 way to guarantee a correct response.
2979 .cindex "local message reception"
2980 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
2981 locally-generated message on the current input. The recipients are given as the
2982 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
2983 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
2984 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
2985 if no other conflicting option is present.
2987 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
2988 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
2989 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
2990 suppressing this for special cases.
2992 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
2993 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
2995 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
2996 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
2997 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3000 .cindex "message" "format"
3001 .cindex "format" "message"
3002 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3003 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3004 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3005 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3006 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3008 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3009 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3011 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3012 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3013 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3014 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3015 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3017 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3018 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3019 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3020 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3021 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3023 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3024 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3025 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3026 .cindex "malware scan test"
3027 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3028 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3029 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3030 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3031 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3032 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3034 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3035 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3036 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3037 This option requires admin privileges.
3039 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3040 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3041 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3045 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3046 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3047 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3048 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3049 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3050 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3051 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3053 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3054 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3055 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3056 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3057 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3059 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3060 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3061 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3062 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3067 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3068 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3069 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3070 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3071 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3072 arguments, for example:
3074 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3076 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3077 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3078 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3079 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3080 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3081 users, the output is as in this example:
3083 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3085 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3086 configuration file is output.
3087 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3088 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3091 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3092 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3093 name will not be output.
3096 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3097 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3098 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3099 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3100 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3101 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3102 written directly into the spool directory.
3104 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3106 exim -bP +local_domains
3108 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3109 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3111 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3112 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3113 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3114 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3115 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3116 that driver are output. For example:
3118 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3120 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3121 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3122 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3123 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3124 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3127 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3128 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3129 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3130 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3131 The output format is one item per line.
3135 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3136 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3137 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3138 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3139 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3140 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3141 to allow any user to see the queue.
3143 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3145 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3146 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3149 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3150 .cindex "size" "of message"
3151 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3152 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3153 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3154 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3155 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3156 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3157 before the sender address.
3159 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3160 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3161 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3163 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3164 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3165 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3166 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3167 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3173 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3174 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3175 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3181 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3182 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3183 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3184 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3189 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3190 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3191 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3192 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3196 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3200 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3205 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3206 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3207 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3208 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3213 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3214 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3215 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3216 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3217 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3219 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3220 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3222 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3223 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3224 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3225 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3226 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3227 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3228 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3229 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3230 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3232 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3233 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3238 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3239 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3240 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3241 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3242 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3243 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3244 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3248 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3249 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3250 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3251 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3252 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3253 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3254 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3255 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3256 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3258 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3259 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3260 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3262 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3263 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3264 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3265 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3267 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3268 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3269 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3271 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3272 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3273 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3274 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3275 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3277 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3278 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3282 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3283 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3284 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3285 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3286 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3287 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3288 messages to the MTA.
3291 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3292 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3293 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3294 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3295 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3296 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3297 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3301 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3302 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3303 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3304 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3305 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3306 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3307 the listening daemon.
3311 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3312 .cindex "address" "testing"
3313 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3314 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3315 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3316 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3317 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3319 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3320 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3322 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3323 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3326 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3327 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3328 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3329 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3330 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3333 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3334 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3335 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3336 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3338 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3339 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3340 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3341 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3344 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3345 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3347 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3348 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3349 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3350 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3351 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3352 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3357 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3358 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3359 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3360 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3361 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3362 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3364 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3365 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3366 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3367 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3368 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3369 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3370 dynamic testing facilities.
3374 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3375 .cindex "address" "verification"
3376 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3377 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3378 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3379 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3380 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3381 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3383 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3384 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3385 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3387 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3388 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3390 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3391 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3394 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3395 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3396 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3397 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3398 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3400 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3401 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3402 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3403 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3404 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3405 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3408 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3409 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3410 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3413 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3414 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3415 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3416 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3418 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3419 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3420 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3421 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3425 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3426 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3433 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3434 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3435 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3436 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3438 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3439 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3440 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3441 each port only when the first connection is received.
3443 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3444 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3446 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3448 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3449 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3450 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3451 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3452 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3453 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3454 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3455 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3456 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3458 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3459 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3460 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3461 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3462 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3463 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3464 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3465 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3466 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3468 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3469 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3470 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3471 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3472 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3473 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3474 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3476 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3477 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3478 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3479 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3480 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3481 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3482 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3484 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3485 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3486 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3489 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3490 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3491 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3492 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3493 specified by this option.
3496 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3498 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3499 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3500 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3501 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3502 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3503 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3505 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3506 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3507 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3508 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3509 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3510 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3511 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3513 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3514 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3515 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3521 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3522 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3525 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3527 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3530 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3532 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3533 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3534 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3535 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3536 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3537 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3538 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3541 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3542 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3543 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3544 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3545 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3546 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3547 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3550 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3551 &`auth `& authenticators
3552 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3553 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3554 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3555 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3556 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3557 &`filter `& filter handling
3558 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3559 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3560 &`ident `& ident lookup
3561 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3562 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3563 &`load `& system load checks
3564 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3565 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3566 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3567 &`memory `& memory handling
3568 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3569 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3570 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3571 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3572 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3573 &`retry `& retry handling
3574 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3575 &`route `& address routing
3576 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3578 &`transport `& transports
3579 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3580 &`verify `& address verification logic
3581 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3583 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3584 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3585 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3586 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3587 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3588 turn everything off.
3590 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3591 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3592 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3593 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3594 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3597 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3598 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3599 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3600 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3601 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3604 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3605 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3608 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3609 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3611 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3613 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3614 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3615 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3616 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3619 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3620 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3621 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3622 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3626 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3627 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3628 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3629 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3630 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3631 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3632 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3633 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3636 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3637 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3638 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3639 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3640 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3642 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3644 .cindex "sender" "name"
3645 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3646 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3647 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3648 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3649 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3650 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3652 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3654 .cindex "sender" "address"
3655 .cindex "address" "sender"
3656 .cindex "trusted users"
3657 .cindex "envelope sender"
3658 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3659 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3660 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3661 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3664 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3665 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3666 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3667 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3670 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3671 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3672 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3673 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3674 examples of shell commands:
3676 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3677 exim -f "" user@domain
3679 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3680 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3683 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3684 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3685 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3686 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3689 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3690 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3691 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3692 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3693 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3694 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3698 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3700 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3702 control = suppress_local_fixups
3704 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3705 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3708 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3712 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3714 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3715 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3716 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3721 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3722 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3723 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3724 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3725 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3726 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3729 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3731 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3732 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3733 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3734 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3735 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3736 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3738 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3741 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3743 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3744 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3745 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3746 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3747 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3748 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3749 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3752 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3753 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3754 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3755 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3756 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3757 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3759 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3760 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3761 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3762 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3764 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3766 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3767 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3768 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3769 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3770 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3771 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3772 can be used only by an admin user.
3774 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3775 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3777 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3778 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3779 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3780 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3781 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3782 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3783 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3784 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3788 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3789 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3790 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3794 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3795 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3796 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3798 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3800 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3801 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3802 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3803 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3804 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3805 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3809 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3810 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3811 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3816 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3817 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3818 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3820 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3822 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3823 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3824 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3825 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3826 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3827 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3828 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3829 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3830 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3831 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3832 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3833 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3834 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3836 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3838 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3839 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3840 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3841 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3842 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3843 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3844 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3845 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3847 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3849 .cindex "freezing messages"
3850 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3851 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3852 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3853 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3854 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3855 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3858 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3860 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3861 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3862 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3863 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3864 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3865 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3866 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3867 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3870 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3872 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3873 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3874 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3875 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3876 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3878 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3880 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3881 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3882 .cindex "removing recipients"
3883 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3884 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3885 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3886 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3887 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3888 can be used only by an admin user.
3890 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3892 .cindex "removing messages"
3893 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3894 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3895 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3896 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3897 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3898 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3899 placed on the queue.
3901 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3903 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3904 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3905 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3906 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3907 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3908 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3909 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3910 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3911 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3913 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3915 .cindex "thawing messages"
3916 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3917 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3918 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3919 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3920 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3921 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3924 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3926 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3927 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3928 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3929 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3931 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3933 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3934 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3935 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3936 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3937 only by an admin user.
3939 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3941 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3942 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3943 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3944 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3945 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3947 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3949 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3950 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3951 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3952 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3956 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3957 treats it that way too.
3961 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3962 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3963 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3964 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3965 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3966 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3967 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3970 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3971 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
3972 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
3973 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
3974 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
3975 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
3976 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
3981 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
3982 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
3983 When combined with &%-bP%& it suppresses the name of an option from being output.
3985 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
3987 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
3990 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
3992 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
3993 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
3994 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
3997 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
3999 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4000 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4001 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4002 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4003 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4004 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4008 .cindex "background delivery"
4009 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4010 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4011 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4012 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4013 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4014 processes to finish.
4016 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4017 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4018 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4019 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4021 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4022 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4023 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4024 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4028 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4029 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4030 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4031 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4032 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4033 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4035 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4036 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4039 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4040 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4042 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4043 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4044 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4045 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4050 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4055 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4056 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4057 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4058 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4059 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4060 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4061 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4062 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4063 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4064 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4069 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4070 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4071 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4072 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4073 configuration file is in effect.
4075 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4076 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4077 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4078 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4079 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4080 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4081 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4082 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4083 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4088 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4089 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4090 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4093 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4095 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4096 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4097 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 any other error. This is
4098 the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4102 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4103 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4104 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4105 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4106 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4110 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4111 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4112 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4113 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4114 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4118 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4119 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4124 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4125 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4130 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4131 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4132 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4133 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4134 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4135 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4138 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4139 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4141 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4143 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4144 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4145 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4146 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4147 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4148 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4150 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4151 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4153 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4155 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4156 followed by a colon and the port number:
4158 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4160 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4161 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4162 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4163 whichever one is last.
4165 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4167 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4168 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4169 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4170 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4171 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4172 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4174 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4176 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4177 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4178 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4179 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4180 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4181 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4183 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4185 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4186 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4187 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4188 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4189 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4190 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4191 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4192 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4194 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4196 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4197 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4198 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4199 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4200 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4202 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4204 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4205 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4206 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4207 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4208 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4209 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4210 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4211 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4212 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4215 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4217 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4218 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4219 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4220 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4221 uses the name it is given.
4223 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4225 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4226 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4227 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4228 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4229 used, when there is no default.
4233 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4234 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4235 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4236 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4240 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4241 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4242 whatever that means.
4244 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4246 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4247 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4248 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4249 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4250 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4251 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4252 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4254 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4256 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4257 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4258 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4259 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4260 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4262 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4264 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4265 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4266 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4267 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4268 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4269 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4273 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4275 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4277 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4278 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4279 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4280 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4281 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4282 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4283 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4284 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4288 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4289 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4290 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4291 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4296 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4297 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4298 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4299 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4302 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4304 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4306 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4308 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4309 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4310 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4311 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`p`&
4312 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4316 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4317 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4318 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4319 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4320 and &%-S%& options).
4322 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4323 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4324 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4325 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4326 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4327 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4330 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4331 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4332 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4333 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4334 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4337 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4338 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4339 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4340 this to be repeated periodically.
4342 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4343 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4344 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4345 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4347 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4348 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4349 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4351 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4352 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4353 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4354 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4358 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4359 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4360 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4361 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4362 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4363 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4366 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4367 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4368 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4369 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4370 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4371 delivered down a single SMTP
4372 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4373 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4374 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4375 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4376 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4379 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4381 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4382 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4383 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4384 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4385 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4387 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4389 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4390 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4391 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4392 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4393 their retry times are tried.
4395 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4397 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4398 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4401 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4403 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4404 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4405 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4408 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4409 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4410 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4411 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4412 starting message id. For example:
4414 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4416 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4417 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4418 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4420 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4422 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4423 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4424 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4425 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4426 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4427 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4429 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4430 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4431 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4432 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4433 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4434 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4435 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4436 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4437 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4439 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4441 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4442 process every 30 minutes.
4444 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4445 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4447 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4449 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4452 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4454 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4456 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4458 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4459 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4460 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4461 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4462 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4463 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4464 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4466 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4467 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4468 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4469 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4470 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4471 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4473 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4474 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4476 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4478 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4479 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4480 applied to each queue run.
4482 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4483 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4484 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4485 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4486 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4487 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4488 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4489 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4490 address will be skipped.
4492 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4493 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4494 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4497 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4498 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4499 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4500 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4501 an arbitrary command instead.
4505 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4507 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4509 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4510 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4511 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4512 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4513 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4514 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4516 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4518 This an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4519 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4520 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4524 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4525 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4526 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4527 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4528 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4529 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4530 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4531 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4532 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4534 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4535 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4536 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4537 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4538 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4539 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4540 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4541 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4542 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4543 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4544 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4546 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4547 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4548 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4549 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4550 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4551 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4553 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4554 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4555 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4556 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4557 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4558 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4559 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4560 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4561 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4565 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4566 compatibility with Sendmail.
4568 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4569 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4570 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4571 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4572 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4573 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4574 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4575 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4580 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4581 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4582 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4583 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4584 set. Exim ignores this option.
4588 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4589 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4590 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4591 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4592 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4593 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4598 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4599 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4600 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4604 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4606 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4607 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4615 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4616 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4617 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4618 . creates a man page for the options.
4619 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4622 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4630 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4633 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4634 "The runtime configuration file"
4636 .cindex "run time configuration"
4637 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4638 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4639 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4640 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4641 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4642 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4643 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4644 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4647 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4648 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4649 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4650 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4651 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4652 actually alter the string.
4654 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4655 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4656 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4657 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4658 existing file in the list.
4661 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4662 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4663 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4664 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4665 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4666 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4667 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4668 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4669 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4670 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4672 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4673 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4674 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4675 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4676 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4678 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4679 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4680 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4681 compromise the Exim user account.
4683 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4684 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4685 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4686 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4687 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4688 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4693 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4694 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4695 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4696 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4697 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4698 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4699 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4700 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4701 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4702 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4703 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4705 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4706 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4707 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4708 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4709 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4710 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4711 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4712 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4713 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4716 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4717 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4718 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4719 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4720 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4722 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4723 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4724 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4725 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4726 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4727 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4729 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4730 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4731 necessarily be discarded.
4732 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4733 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4734 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4735 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4736 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4737 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4739 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4740 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4741 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4742 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4743 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4744 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4745 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4747 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4748 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4749 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4753 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4754 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4755 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4756 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4757 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4758 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4759 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4763 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4766 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4767 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4768 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4770 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4771 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4772 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4774 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4775 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4776 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4778 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4779 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4780 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4781 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4784 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4785 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4786 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4788 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4789 want to use this feature, you must set
4791 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4793 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4794 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4797 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4798 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4799 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4800 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4802 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4803 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4804 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4805 and does not introduce a comment.
4807 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4808 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4809 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4810 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4811 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4813 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4814 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4815 change settings as required.
4817 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4818 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4819 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4820 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4821 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4826 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4827 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4828 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4829 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4830 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4831 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4834 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4835 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4837 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4838 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4839 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4842 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4843 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4844 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4845 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4847 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4848 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4851 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4854 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4855 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4860 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4861 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4862 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4863 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4864 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4865 definition, and must be of the form
4867 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4869 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4870 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4871 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4872 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4873 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4875 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4876 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4877 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4879 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4880 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4881 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4882 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4883 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4884 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4885 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4888 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4889 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4891 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4892 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4893 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4894 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4895 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4896 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4899 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4900 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4901 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4906 MAC == updated value
4908 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4909 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4910 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4911 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4915 MAC == MAC and something added
4917 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4918 from a number of other files.
4920 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4921 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4922 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4923 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4924 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4929 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4930 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4931 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4932 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4934 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4935 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4937 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4939 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4941 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4942 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4943 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4946 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4947 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4948 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4949 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4950 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4951 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4952 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4954 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4955 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
4956 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
4960 message_size_limit = 50M
4962 message_size_limit = 100M
4965 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined, and 100M
4966 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
4967 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
4968 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
4970 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
4971 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
4972 in this line"& will always be true.
4974 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
4975 to clarify complicated nestings.
4979 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
4980 .cindex "common option syntax"
4981 .cindex "syntax of common options"
4982 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
4983 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
4984 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
4985 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
4986 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
4987 space) and then the value. For example:
4989 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
4991 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
4992 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
4993 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
4994 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
4995 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
4996 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
4997 word &"hide"&. For example:
4999 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5001 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5003 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5005 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5006 all instances of the same driver.
5008 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5009 that are found in option settings.
5012 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5013 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5014 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5015 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5016 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5017 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5018 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5019 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5020 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5021 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5022 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5023 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5028 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5033 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5038 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5039 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5040 .cindex "format" "integer"
5041 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5042 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5043 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5044 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5047 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5048 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
5049 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5050 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5051 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5055 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5056 .cindex "integer format"
5057 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5058 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5059 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5060 Such options are always output in octal.
5063 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5064 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5065 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5066 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5067 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5071 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5072 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5073 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5074 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5075 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5085 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5086 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5087 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5091 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5092 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5093 .cindex "format" "string"
5094 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5095 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5096 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5097 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5098 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5099 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5100 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5101 therefore equivalent:
5103 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5104 trusted_users = uucp:\
5105 # This comment line is ignored
5108 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5109 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5110 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5111 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5112 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5115 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5116 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5117 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5119 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5120 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5124 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5125 character, that character replaces the pair.
5127 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5128 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5129 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5130 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5131 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5132 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5135 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5136 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5137 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5138 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5139 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5140 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5141 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5142 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5143 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5144 within a quoted configuration string.
5147 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5148 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5149 .cindex "format" "user name"
5150 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5151 .cindex "format" "group name"
5152 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5153 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5154 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5155 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5158 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5159 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5160 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5161 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5162 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5163 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5164 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5165 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5166 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5167 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5168 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5170 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5171 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5172 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5173 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5174 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5175 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5178 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5180 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5182 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5183 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5184 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5185 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5187 .section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
5188 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5189 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5190 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5191 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5192 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5193 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5194 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5196 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5198 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5199 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5200 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5202 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5203 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5204 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5205 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5206 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5207 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5208 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5209 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5210 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5212 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5214 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5215 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5216 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5217 the value in quotes. For example:
5219 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5221 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5222 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5223 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5224 enclosing an empty list item.
5228 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5229 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5230 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5231 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5233 senders = user@domain :
5235 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5236 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5237 items, the second of which is empty:
5239 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5241 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5242 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5243 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5244 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5248 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5249 is at the end of the list.
5254 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5255 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5256 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5257 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5258 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5259 a sequence of lines like this:
5261 <&'instance name'&>:
5266 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5267 followed by three options settings:
5272 transport = local_delivery
5274 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5275 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5276 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5277 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5278 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5279 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5281 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5282 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5284 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5285 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5286 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5287 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5288 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5291 .cindex "generic options"
5292 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5293 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5294 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5295 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5296 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5297 .cindex "private options"
5298 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5299 they all have default values.
5301 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5302 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5303 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5305 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5306 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5307 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5308 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5309 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5310 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5311 configuration lines:
5316 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5317 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5318 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5319 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5325 command_timeout = 10s
5327 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5328 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5331 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5332 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5333 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5341 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5342 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5344 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5345 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5346 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5347 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5348 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5349 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5350 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5351 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5352 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5353 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5354 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5358 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5359 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5360 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5363 # primary_hostname =
5365 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5366 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5367 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5368 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5370 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5372 domainlist local_domains = @
5373 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5374 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5376 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5377 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5378 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5379 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5381 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5382 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5385 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5386 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5387 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5388 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5389 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5390 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5392 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5393 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5394 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5395 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5396 domain is permitted.
5398 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5399 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5400 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5401 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5402 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5403 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5405 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5406 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5407 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5409 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5411 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5412 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5414 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5415 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5416 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5417 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5418 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5419 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5420 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5421 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5422 contents of a message to be checked.
5424 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5426 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5427 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5429 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5430 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5431 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5432 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5434 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5436 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5437 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5438 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5440 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5441 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5442 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5443 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5444 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5445 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5446 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5448 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5450 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5451 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5453 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5454 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5455 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5456 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5457 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5458 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5459 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5460 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5461 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5462 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5463 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5464 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5465 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5466 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5467 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5468 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5470 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5473 # qualify_recipient =
5475 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5476 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5477 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5478 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5479 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5480 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5482 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5483 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5484 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5485 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5487 # allow_domain_literals
5489 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5490 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5491 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5492 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5493 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5494 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5496 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5500 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5501 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5502 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5503 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5504 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5505 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5506 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5507 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5509 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5510 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5515 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5516 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5517 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5518 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5519 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5520 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5523 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5524 1413 (hence their names):
5527 rfc1413_query_timeout = 5s
5529 These settings cause Exim to make ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5530 You can limit the hosts to which these calls are made, or change the timeout
5531 that is used. If you set the timeout to zero, all ident calls are disabled.
5532 Although they are cheap and can provide useful information for tracing problem
5533 messages, some hosts and firewalls have problems with ident calls. This can
5534 result in a timeout instead of an immediate refused connection, leading to
5535 delays on starting up an incoming SMTP session.
5537 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5538 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5539 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5540 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5542 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5543 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5545 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5546 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5548 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5550 # percent_hack_domains =
5552 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5553 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5554 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5556 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5557 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5558 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5559 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5560 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5561 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5562 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5563 always bounce messages.
5565 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5566 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5568 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5569 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5570 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5571 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5572 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5576 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5577 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5578 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5579 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5580 It starts with the line
5584 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5585 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5586 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5588 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5589 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5590 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5591 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5592 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5593 result of the ACL processing.
5597 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5602 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5603 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5604 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5605 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5606 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5607 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5609 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5610 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5611 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5614 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5615 domains = +local_domains
5616 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5618 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5619 domains = !+local_domains
5620 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5622 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5623 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5624 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5625 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5626 in Internet mail addresses.
5628 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5629 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5630 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5631 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5632 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5633 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5634 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5635 policy of being as safe as possible.
5637 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5638 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5639 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5640 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5641 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5642 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5644 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5645 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5646 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5647 have to modify this rule.
5649 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5650 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5651 common convention of local parts constructed as
5652 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5653 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5654 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5655 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5656 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5657 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5659 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5660 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5661 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5662 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5663 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5664 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5665 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5667 accept local_parts = postmaster
5668 domains = +local_domains
5670 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5671 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5672 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5673 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5674 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5676 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5677 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5678 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5680 require verify = sender
5682 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5683 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5684 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5685 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5686 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5687 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5688 discusses the details of address verification.
5690 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5691 control = submission
5693 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5694 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5695 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5696 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5697 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5698 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5699 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5700 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5701 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5703 accept authenticated = *
5704 control = submission
5706 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5707 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5708 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5709 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5710 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5711 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5713 require message = relay not permitted
5714 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5716 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5717 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5719 require verify = recipient
5721 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5722 fails, the address is rejected.
5724 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5725 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5727 # dnslists = black.list.example
5729 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5730 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5731 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5732 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5734 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5735 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5736 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5739 # require verify = csa
5741 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5742 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5747 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5748 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5752 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5753 of this ACL are commented out:
5756 # message = This message contains a virus \
5759 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5760 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5761 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5762 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5764 # warn spam = nobody
5765 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5766 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5767 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5768 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5770 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5771 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5772 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5773 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5774 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5775 whatever the spam score.
5779 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5782 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5783 .cindex "default" "routers"
5784 .cindex "routers" "default"
5785 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5790 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5791 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5792 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5793 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5794 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5797 # driver = ipliteral
5798 # domains = !+local_domains
5799 # transport = remote_smtp
5801 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5802 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5803 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5804 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5805 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5809 domains = ! +local_domains
5810 transport = remote_smtp
5811 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5814 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5815 domains. This is specified by the line
5817 domains = ! +local_domains
5819 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5820 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5821 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5822 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5823 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5824 passed on to the following routers.
5826 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5827 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5828 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5829 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5830 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5832 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5833 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5834 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5835 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5836 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5837 the address fails and is bounced.
5839 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5840 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5841 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5842 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5843 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5844 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5845 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5852 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5854 file_transport = address_file
5855 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5857 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5858 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5859 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5860 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5861 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5864 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5865 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5866 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5867 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5872 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5873 # local_part_suffix_optional
5874 file = $home/.forward
5879 file_transport = address_file
5880 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5881 reply_transport = address_reply
5883 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5884 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5885 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5886 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5887 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5890 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5891 # local_part_suffix_optional
5893 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5894 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5895 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5896 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5897 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5898 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5899 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5901 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5902 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5903 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5904 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5906 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5907 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5908 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5909 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5910 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5911 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5912 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5914 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5915 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5916 There are two reasons for doing this:
5919 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5920 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5923 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5924 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5925 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5926 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5930 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5931 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5932 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5933 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5935 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5936 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5937 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5939 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5941 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5947 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5948 # local_part_suffix_optional
5949 transport = local_delivery
5951 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
5952 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
5953 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
5954 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
5955 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
5958 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
5959 .cindex "default" "transports"
5960 .cindex "transports" "default"
5961 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
5962 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
5963 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
5967 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
5972 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections. All its
5973 options are defaulted. The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
5977 file = /var/mail/$local_part
5984 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
5985 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
5986 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
5987 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
5988 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
5989 show how this can be done.
5991 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
5992 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
5993 similarly-named options above.
5999 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6000 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6001 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
6010 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6011 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6012 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6017 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6022 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6023 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6024 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6025 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6026 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6027 introduced by the line
6031 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6034 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6036 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6037 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6038 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6039 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
6041 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6042 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6043 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6046 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6047 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6051 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6052 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6056 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6057 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6058 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6060 begin authenticators
6062 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6063 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6064 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6065 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6066 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6067 to support most MUA software.
6069 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6072 # driver = plaintext
6073 # server_set_id = $auth2
6074 # server_prompts = :
6075 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6076 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6078 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6081 # driver = plaintext
6082 # server_set_id = $auth1
6083 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6084 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6085 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6088 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6089 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6090 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6091 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6092 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6093 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6094 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6095 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6097 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6098 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6099 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6100 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6102 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6103 usercode and password are in different positions.
6104 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6106 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6110 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6111 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6113 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6115 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6117 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6118 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6119 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6120 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6121 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6122 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6124 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6125 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6126 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6127 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6128 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6131 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6132 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6133 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6134 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6136 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6138 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6139 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6140 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6141 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6142 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6143 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6146 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6147 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6148 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6149 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6150 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6151 match anywhere in the subject string.
6153 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6154 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6156 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6158 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6161 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6163 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6164 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6168 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6169 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6171 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6172 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6173 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6174 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6175 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6176 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6179 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6180 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6181 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6182 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6183 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6185 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6186 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6187 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6188 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6189 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6192 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6193 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6194 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6195 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6196 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6197 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6199 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6200 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6201 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6202 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6203 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6205 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6206 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6208 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6209 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6210 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6211 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6212 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6214 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6215 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6217 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6218 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6220 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6221 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6222 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6227 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6228 matches the list item.
6230 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6231 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6233 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6235 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6236 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6237 causes a second lookup to occur.
6239 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6240 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6241 lookup is permitted.
6244 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6245 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6246 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6247 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6250 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6251 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6252 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6254 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6255 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6256 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6257 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6260 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6261 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6262 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6267 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6268 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6269 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6274 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6275 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6276 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6277 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6280 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6281 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6282 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6283 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6284 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6285 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6286 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6287 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6288 be found in several places:
6290 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6291 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6292 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6294 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6295 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6296 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6297 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6299 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6300 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6301 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6302 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6303 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6304 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6305 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6307 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6308 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6309 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6310 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6311 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6312 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6313 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6315 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6316 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6318 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6319 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6320 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6321 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6322 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6323 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6324 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6326 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6327 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6328 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6330 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6331 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6332 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6333 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6334 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6335 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6336 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6337 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6338 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6339 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6341 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6342 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6343 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6344 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6345 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6346 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6347 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6348 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6349 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6351 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6352 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6353 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6354 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6355 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6356 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6357 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6359 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6360 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6361 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6362 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6364 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6365 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6366 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6367 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6368 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6370 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6371 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6372 lookup types support only literal keys.
6374 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6375 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6376 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6378 .cindex "linear search"
6379 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6380 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6381 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6382 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6383 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6384 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6385 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6386 in the file is used.
6388 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6389 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6390 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6391 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6392 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6397 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6398 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6399 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6400 wildcarding of any kind.
6402 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6403 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6404 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6405 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6406 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6407 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6408 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6409 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6410 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6413 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6414 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6415 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6416 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6417 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6418 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6419 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6420 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6423 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6424 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6425 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6426 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6427 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6428 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6429 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6430 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6431 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6433 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6434 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6435 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6436 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6438 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6439 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6442 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6444 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6445 *fish data for anythingfish
6448 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6449 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6451 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6453 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6454 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6455 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6457 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6459 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6460 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6461 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6463 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6466 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6467 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6468 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6469 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6470 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6472 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6473 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6474 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6475 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6476 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6479 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6480 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6481 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6484 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6486 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6489 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6490 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6491 be followed by optional colons.
6493 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6494 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6495 lookup types support only literal keys.
6499 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6500 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6501 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6502 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6503 many of them are given in later sections.
6506 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6507 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6508 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6509 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6510 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6512 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6513 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6514 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6516 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6517 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6518 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6519 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6520 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6521 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6522 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6524 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6525 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6526 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6527 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6529 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6530 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6531 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6532 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6534 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6535 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6536 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6537 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6539 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6540 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6541 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6542 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6543 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6544 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6545 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6546 password value. For example:
6548 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6551 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6552 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6553 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6554 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6557 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6558 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6559 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6560 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6563 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6564 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6566 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6567 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6568 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6569 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6570 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6571 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6572 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6573 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6574 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6576 require condition = \
6577 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6579 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6580 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6581 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6582 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6587 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6588 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6589 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6590 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6591 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6592 options such as a list of local domains.
6594 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6595 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6596 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6597 or may give up altogether.
6601 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6602 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6603 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6604 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6605 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6606 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6607 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6608 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6610 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6611 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6612 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6614 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6615 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6616 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6618 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6619 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6620 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6621 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6622 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6623 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6624 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6625 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6626 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6627 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6629 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6631 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6632 looks up these keys, in this order:
6638 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6639 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6640 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6641 Exim move on to try the next key.
6645 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6646 .cindex "partial matching"
6647 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6648 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6649 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6650 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6651 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6652 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6653 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6654 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6655 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6656 a key in a DBM file is
6658 *.dates.fict.example
6660 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6661 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6662 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6665 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6666 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6667 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6669 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6670 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6671 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6672 partial matching keys
6673 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6674 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6675 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6677 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6678 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6679 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6680 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6681 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6682 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6685 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6686 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6687 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6688 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6689 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6690 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6692 2250.dates.fict.example
6693 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6694 *.dates.fict.example
6697 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6700 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6701 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6702 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6703 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6704 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6705 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6707 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6709 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6710 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6711 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6712 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6714 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6716 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6717 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6719 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6720 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6721 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6724 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6726 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6727 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6729 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6730 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6731 for &"*"& on its own.
6733 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6737 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6738 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6739 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6740 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6741 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6742 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6743 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6745 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6746 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6747 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6748 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6749 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6754 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6755 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6756 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6757 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6758 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6759 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6760 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6762 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6763 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6764 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6765 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6766 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6767 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6769 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6770 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6776 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6777 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6778 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6779 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6780 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6781 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6785 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6786 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6788 [name="$local_part"]
6790 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6791 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6792 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6793 of the following form is provided:
6795 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6797 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6799 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6801 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6802 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6803 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6808 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6809 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6810 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6811 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6812 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6813 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6814 an expansion string could contain:
6816 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6818 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6819 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6820 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6821 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6823 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SPF, SRV, and TXT,
6824 and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6825 configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6826 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6827 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6829 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6831 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6832 altered and nothing is added.
6834 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6835 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6836 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6837 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6838 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6840 For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6841 single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6842 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6843 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6844 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6845 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6847 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6849 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6850 white space is ignored.
6852 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6853 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6854 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6855 unless a separator for them is specified using a comma after the separator
6856 character followed immediately by the TXT record item separator. To concatenate
6857 items without a separator, use a semicolon instead. For SPF records the
6858 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6860 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6861 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6862 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6864 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6865 white space is ignored.
6867 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6868 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6869 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6870 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
6871 the pseudo-type MXH:
6873 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6875 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
6878 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
6879 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
6880 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6881 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6882 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6883 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6884 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6885 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6887 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6888 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6890 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6891 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
6892 the name servers for &%edu%&.
6894 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6895 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6896 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6897 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6898 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
6901 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6902 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
6903 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
6904 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
6905 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
6906 result of a successful lookup such as:
6908 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
6910 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
6911 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
6912 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
6915 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
6916 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
6917 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
6918 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
6919 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
6921 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
6922 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6923 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
6925 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
6926 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
6927 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
6928 case, it does not treat it as a list.
6930 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
6931 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
6932 different separator can be specified, as described above.
6934 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6935 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6936 an optional keyword followed by a comma that may appear before the record
6937 type. The possible keywords are &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and
6938 &"defer_lax"&. With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6939 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6940 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6941 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6942 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6943 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6945 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6946 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6948 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6949 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6954 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
6955 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
6956 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6957 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
6958 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
6959 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
6960 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
6961 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
6962 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
6963 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
6964 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
6965 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
6967 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
6968 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
6969 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
6970 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
6971 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
6973 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
6974 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
6976 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
6977 the way they handle the results of a query:
6980 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
6983 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
6984 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
6986 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
6987 from all of them are returned.
6991 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
6992 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
6993 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
6994 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
6997 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
6998 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
6999 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7000 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7002 data = ${lookup ldap \
7003 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7004 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7006 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7007 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7008 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7009 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7011 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7012 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7013 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7016 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7017 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7018 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7019 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7020 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7021 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7023 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7024 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7032 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7033 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7037 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7039 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7043 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7045 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7047 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7049 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7050 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7051 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7055 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7056 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7057 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7059 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7063 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7065 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7067 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7069 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7070 authentication below.
7073 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7074 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7075 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7076 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7077 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7080 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7082 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7083 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7084 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7085 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7086 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7087 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7088 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7089 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7090 failures, and timeouts.
7092 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7093 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7094 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7095 doubled. For example
7097 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7099 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7100 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7101 the local host) is used.
7103 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7104 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7105 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7106 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7109 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7110 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7111 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7112 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7114 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7116 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7117 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7119 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7121 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7122 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7123 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7124 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7125 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7126 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7127 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7130 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7131 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7132 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7135 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7138 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7142 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7143 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7147 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7148 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7149 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7150 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7151 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7152 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7153 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7154 them. The following names are recognized:
7156 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7157 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7158 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7159 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7160 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7161 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7162 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7164 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7165 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7166 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7167 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7169 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7170 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7171 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7172 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7173 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7174 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7175 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7176 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7177 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7179 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7180 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7183 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7184 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7187 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7188 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7191 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7192 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7193 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7194 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7196 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7197 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7198 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7200 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7201 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7202 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7203 quoting has two advantages:
7206 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7207 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7209 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7212 For example, a setting such as
7214 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7216 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7218 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7219 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7220 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7221 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7225 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7226 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7231 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7232 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7233 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7234 as a sequence of values, for example
7236 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7238 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7239 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7240 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7241 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7242 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7245 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7246 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7247 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7249 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7250 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7251 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7252 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7253 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7254 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7255 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7257 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7258 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7259 &%attr1%& has two values, whereas &%attr2%& has only one value:
7261 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7264 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7267 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7268 attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7270 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7271 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7273 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7274 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs. You can
7275 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7276 results of LDAP lookups.
7281 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7282 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7283 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7284 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7285 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7286 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7287 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7288 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7290 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7292 might return the string
7294 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7295 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7297 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7299 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7305 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7306 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7307 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7311 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7312 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7313 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7314 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7315 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7316 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7317 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7318 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7319 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7320 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7321 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7322 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7325 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7328 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7329 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7331 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7336 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7338 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7339 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7340 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7344 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7345 with a newline between the data for each row.
7348 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7349 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7350 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7351 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7352 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7353 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7354 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7355 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7356 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7357 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7358 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7359 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7361 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7362 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7363 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7364 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7365 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7366 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7368 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7370 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7371 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7372 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7374 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7375 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7377 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7378 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7379 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7380 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7381 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7382 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7384 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7385 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7386 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7387 itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7388 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7389 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7390 characters are not special.
7392 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7393 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7394 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7395 done by starting the query with
7397 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7399 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7401 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7402 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7403 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7406 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7408 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7409 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7410 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7412 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7413 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7414 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7417 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7421 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7423 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7425 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7426 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7427 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7429 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7433 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7434 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7435 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7436 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7437 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7439 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7440 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7442 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7443 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7445 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7448 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7449 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7451 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7452 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7453 is zero because no rows are affected.
7456 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7457 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7458 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7459 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7460 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7463 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7465 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7466 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7467 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7469 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7470 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7473 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7474 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7475 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7476 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7477 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7478 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7479 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7480 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7481 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7483 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7484 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7486 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7488 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7489 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7491 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7492 quote, which it doubles.
7494 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7495 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7496 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7497 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7498 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7499 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7505 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7506 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7508 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7509 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7510 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7511 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7512 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7513 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7514 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7515 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7516 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7518 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7519 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7520 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7521 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7525 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7526 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7527 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7528 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7529 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7530 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7531 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7532 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7535 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7536 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7537 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7539 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7540 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7541 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7542 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7543 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7545 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7546 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7548 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7549 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7550 senders based on the receiving domain.
7555 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7556 .cindex "list" "negation"
7557 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7558 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7559 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7560 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7561 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7562 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7564 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7565 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7566 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7567 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7568 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7570 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7572 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7573 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7574 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7576 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7578 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7579 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7580 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7582 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7583 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7588 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7589 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7590 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7591 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7592 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7593 file names are not allowed,
7594 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7595 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7599 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7600 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7602 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7603 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7604 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7606 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7610 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7611 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7612 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7613 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7615 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7616 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7618 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7620 and the file contains the lines
7625 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7626 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7630 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7631 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7632 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7633 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7634 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7635 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7636 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7637 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7639 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7640 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7641 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7642 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7647 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7648 .cindex "named lists"
7649 .cindex "list" "named"
7650 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7651 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7652 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7653 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7654 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7655 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7656 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7658 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7660 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7661 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7662 configured with the line
7664 domains = +local_domains
7666 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7667 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7671 domains = ! +local_domains
7672 transport = remote_smtp
7675 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7676 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7677 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7678 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7680 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7681 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7683 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7685 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7686 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7687 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7689 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7690 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7691 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7693 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7694 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7696 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7697 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7698 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7700 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7702 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7703 referenced lists if you can.
7705 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7706 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7707 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7709 domains = +local_domains
7711 on several of your routers
7712 or in several ACL statements,
7713 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7714 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7715 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7716 the same each time they are referenced.
7718 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7719 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7720 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7721 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7725 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7726 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7727 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7728 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7729 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7732 ALIST = host1 : host2
7733 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7735 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7737 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7739 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7742 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7743 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7745 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7747 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7751 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7752 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7753 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7754 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7755 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7756 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7757 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7758 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7759 message. For example:
7761 domainlist special_domains = \
7762 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7764 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7765 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7766 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7767 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7768 same list each time.
7770 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7771 cache the result anyway. For example:
7773 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7775 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7776 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7780 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7781 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7782 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7783 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7784 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7787 .cindex "primary host name"
7788 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7789 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7790 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7791 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7792 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7793 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7794 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7795 differ only in their names.
7797 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7798 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7799 .cindex "domain literal"
7800 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7801 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7802 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7803 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7804 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7805 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7808 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7809 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7810 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7811 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7812 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7813 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7814 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7815 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7816 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7817 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7818 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7820 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7821 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7822 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7823 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7824 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7826 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7827 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7828 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7829 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7830 on a router). For example:
7832 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7834 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7835 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7837 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7838 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7839 contain negative items.
7841 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7842 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7843 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7845 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7846 an.other.domain : ...
7848 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7849 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7851 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7852 an.other.domain ? ...
7855 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
7856 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
7857 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
7858 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7859 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
7860 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7861 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7862 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7863 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
7867 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
7868 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
7869 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7870 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7871 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7872 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
7873 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
7874 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
7875 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
7877 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7878 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7879 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
7880 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
7881 expression by expansion, of course).
7883 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
7884 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
7885 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
7886 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
7887 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
7888 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
7890 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
7892 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
7893 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
7894 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
7895 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
7896 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
7897 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
7898 other statements in the same ACL.
7901 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
7902 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
7904 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
7906 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
7907 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
7910 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
7911 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
7912 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
7913 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
7914 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
7915 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
7918 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
7919 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
7920 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
7921 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
7923 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
7924 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
7926 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
7927 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
7928 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
7929 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
7930 variable and can be referred to in other options.
7932 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
7933 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
7934 between the pattern and the domain.
7937 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
7939 domainlist funny_domains = \
7942 *.foundation.fict.example : \
7943 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
7944 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
7945 nis;domains.byname : \
7946 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
7948 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
7949 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
7950 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
7951 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
7952 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
7957 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
7958 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
7959 .cindex "list" "host list"
7960 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
7961 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
7962 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
7963 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
7964 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
7965 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
7966 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
7969 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
7970 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
7971 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
7972 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
7973 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
7974 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
7977 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
7978 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
7979 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
7983 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
7984 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
7985 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
7986 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
7987 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
7988 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
7989 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
7992 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
7993 inspecting its IP address:
7996 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
7997 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
7998 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
7999 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8000 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8001 with the IP address of the subject host.
8003 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8004 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8005 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8006 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8007 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8010 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8011 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8012 domain name, as just described.
8015 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8016 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8017 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8018 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8019 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8020 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8021 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8022 that can never match a client host.
8025 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8026 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8027 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8028 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8030 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8034 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8035 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8036 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8037 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8038 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8039 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8040 significant end of the address.
8042 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8043 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8044 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8045 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8049 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8050 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8053 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8055 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8056 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8058 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8059 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8062 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8064 could make use of a file containing
8069 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8070 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8071 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8073 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8076 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8082 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8083 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8084 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8085 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8086 address, the pattern takes this form:
8088 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8092 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8094 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8095 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8096 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8097 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8098 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8099 returned by the lookup is not used.
8101 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8102 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8103 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8104 patterns of this form:
8106 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8110 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8112 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8113 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8114 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8115 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8116 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8118 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8119 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8120 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8121 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8122 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8123 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8124 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8125 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8126 addresses are always used.
8128 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8129 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8130 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8133 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8134 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8135 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8136 case the IP address is used on its own.
8140 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8141 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8142 .cindex "unknown host name"
8143 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8144 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8145 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8146 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8147 address to match against, as described in the section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8150 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8151 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8152 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8153 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8154 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8155 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8156 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8158 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8159 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8161 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8162 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8163 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8164 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8165 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8166 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8167 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8168 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8169 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8171 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8172 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8174 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8175 .cindex "alias for host"
8176 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8177 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8180 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8181 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8182 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8183 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8184 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8187 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8188 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8189 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8190 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8191 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8192 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8193 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8198 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8199 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8200 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8201 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8202 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8204 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8206 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8207 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8208 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8215 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8216 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8217 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8218 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8219 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8220 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8222 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8223 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8225 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8226 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8227 By default, Exim behaves as if the host does not match the list. This may not
8228 always be what you want to happen. To change Exim's behaviour, the special
8229 items &`+include_unknown`& or &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at
8230 top level &-- they are not recognized in an indirected file).
8233 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8234 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8236 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8238 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8239 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8242 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8243 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8246 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8249 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8250 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8251 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8254 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8255 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8259 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8261 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8262 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8263 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8264 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8265 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8266 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8267 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8268 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8269 host lists such as whitelists.
8273 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8274 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8275 .cindex "unknown host name"
8276 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8277 If a pattern is of the form
8279 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8283 dbm;/host/accept/list
8285 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8286 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8289 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8290 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8291 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8292 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8293 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8294 lookup, both using the same file.
8298 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8299 If a pattern is of the form
8301 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8303 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8304 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8305 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8307 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8308 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8310 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8311 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8312 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8315 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8316 looks up the host name if has not already done so. (See section
8317 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8319 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8320 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8321 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8322 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8323 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8324 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8328 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8330 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8331 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same
8332 host list, you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, in an
8335 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8337 The reason for this lies in the left-to-right way that Exim processes lists.
8338 It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an
8339 item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to
8340 compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8341 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even if its
8342 IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8344 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8345 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8347 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8348 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8350 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8351 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs.
8357 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8358 .cindex "list" "address list"
8359 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8360 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8361 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8362 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8363 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8364 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8365 using this option setting:
8369 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8370 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8371 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8372 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8374 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8377 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8379 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8380 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8381 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8382 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8383 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8384 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8385 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8387 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8388 *@+hostile_domains:\
8389 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8390 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8392 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8393 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8394 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8395 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8396 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8398 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8399 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8400 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8401 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8402 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8404 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8407 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8408 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8412 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8413 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8414 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8415 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8416 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8417 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8418 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8420 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8421 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8423 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8424 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8427 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8428 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8429 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8432 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8433 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8434 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8436 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8437 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8438 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8439 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8441 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8442 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8444 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8445 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8446 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8447 default. For example, with this lookup:
8449 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8451 the file could contains lines like this:
8453 user1@domain1.example
8456 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8459 nimrod@jaeger.example
8463 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8464 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8466 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8468 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8469 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8471 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8472 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8473 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8477 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8478 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8483 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8484 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8485 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8486 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8487 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8488 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8489 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8490 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8491 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8493 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8494 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8495 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8496 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8497 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8500 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8502 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8504 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8506 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8508 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8509 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8510 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8511 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8512 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8513 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8515 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8518 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8521 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8522 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8523 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8524 might have entries like
8526 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8527 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8530 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8531 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8532 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8533 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8535 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8536 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8537 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8540 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8541 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8542 can only return a single list of local parts.
8545 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8546 in these two examples:
8549 senders = *@+my_list
8551 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8552 example it is a named domain list.
8557 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8558 .cindex "case of local parts"
8559 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8560 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8561 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8562 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8563 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8564 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8565 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8566 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8569 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8570 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8571 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8572 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8573 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8574 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8575 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8578 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8579 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8580 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8581 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8582 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8583 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8584 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8585 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8589 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8590 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8591 .cindex "local part" "list"
8592 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8593 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8594 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8595 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8596 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8597 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8598 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8599 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8601 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8602 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8603 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8604 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8605 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8606 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8607 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8609 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8614 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8615 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8617 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8618 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8619 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8620 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8622 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8623 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8624 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8625 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8626 escape character, as described in the following section.
8628 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8629 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8630 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
8631 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8632 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8637 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8638 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8639 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8640 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8641 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8642 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8643 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8644 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8646 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8647 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8648 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8649 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8651 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8653 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8654 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8659 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8660 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8661 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8662 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8663 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8664 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8665 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8668 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8669 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8670 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8673 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8674 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8675 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8677 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8678 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8679 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8680 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8681 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8682 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8683 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8686 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8687 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8688 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8691 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8692 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8693 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8694 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8696 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8698 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8699 Exim message identifier. For example:
8701 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8703 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8704 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8707 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8708 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8709 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8710 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8711 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8712 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8713 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8714 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8715 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8716 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8717 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8718 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8724 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8725 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8726 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8727 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8728 white space is significant.
8731 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8732 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8733 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8738 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8739 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8740 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8741 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8742 given, the expansion fails.
8744 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8745 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8746 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8747 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8751 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8752 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8753 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8754 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8755 string easier to understand.
8757 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8758 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8759 expansion item below.
8762 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8763 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
8764 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
8765 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
8766 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
8767 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
8768 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
8769 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
8770 are overwritten. If the ACL sets
8771 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
8772 the result of the expansion.
8773 If no message was set and the ACL returned accept or deny
8774 the value is an empty string.
8775 If the ACL returned defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
8778 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
8779 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8781 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
8782 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
8786 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
8787 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
8788 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
8790 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
8791 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
8792 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
8793 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
8794 must have the following type:
8796 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
8798 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
8799 function should return one of the following values:
8801 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
8802 into the expanded string that is being built.
8804 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
8805 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
8807 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
8808 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
8810 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
8812 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
8813 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
8814 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
8816 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
8817 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8818 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
8819 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
8820 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
8821 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
8822 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
8825 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
8828 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
8829 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
8830 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
8831 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
8832 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
8833 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8834 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8835 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8836 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8838 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8839 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8840 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
8843 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
8844 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
8846 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
8847 appear, for example:
8849 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
8851 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
8852 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
8855 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
8856 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8857 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
8858 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
8859 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
8860 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
8861 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
8862 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
8863 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
8864 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
8865 <&'string3'&> as before.
8867 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
8868 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
8869 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
8870 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
8871 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
8872 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
8873 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
8874 provided. For example:
8876 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8880 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8882 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
8883 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
8886 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
8887 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
8888 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
8890 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8891 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8892 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
8893 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
8894 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
8895 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
8896 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
8898 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
8900 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
8901 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8904 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8905 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
8906 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
8907 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
8908 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
8909 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
8911 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
8912 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
8913 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
8914 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8916 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8918 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
8919 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
8920 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
8921 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
8922 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
8924 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
8926 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
8927 letters appear. For example:
8929 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
8930 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
8931 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
8934 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8935 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8936 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8937 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8938 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8939 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
8940 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
8941 .vindex "&$header_$&"
8942 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
8943 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
8944 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
8945 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
8946 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
8947 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
8951 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
8952 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
8953 lines) may be present.
8955 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
8956 the data in the header line is interpreted.
8959 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
8960 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
8961 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
8964 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
8965 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
8966 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
8967 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
8968 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
8969 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
8970 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
8971 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
8974 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
8975 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
8976 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
8977 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
8978 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
8979 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
8982 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
8983 command of the following form:
8985 headers charset "UTF-8"
8987 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
8988 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
8989 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
8990 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
8991 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
8994 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
8995 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
8996 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
8997 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
8999 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9000 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9001 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9002 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9003 router or transport are not accessible.
9005 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
9006 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
9007 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9008 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9009 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
9010 by earlier ACLs are visible.
9012 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9013 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9014 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9015 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
9016 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
9017 replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
9018 &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
9020 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9021 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9022 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9023 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9024 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9025 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9026 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9027 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9030 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9031 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9033 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9034 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9035 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9036 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9037 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9038 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9039 present. For example:
9041 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9043 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9046 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9048 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9049 an Exim configuration:
9051 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9053 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9056 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9057 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9058 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9060 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9061 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9062 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9063 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9064 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9065 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9068 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9069 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9070 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9071 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9072 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9073 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9075 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9077 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9078 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9079 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9080 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9081 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9083 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9084 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9085 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9087 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9091 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9094 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9095 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9096 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9097 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9098 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9099 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9100 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9103 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9105 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9106 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9107 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9110 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9111 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9112 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9113 described in the next item.
9115 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9116 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9117 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9118 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9119 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9120 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9121 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9122 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9123 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9125 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9126 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9127 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9128 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9129 out by the system administrator.
9132 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9133 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9134 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9135 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9136 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9137 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9138 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9139 original lookup fails.
9141 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9142 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9143 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9144 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9145 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9146 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9147 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9148 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9150 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9151 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9152 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9153 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9155 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9156 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9157 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9158 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9160 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9162 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9164 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9165 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9167 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9172 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9173 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9175 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9176 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9177 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9178 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9179 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9180 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9182 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9184 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9185 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9186 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9188 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9189 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9190 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9191 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9192 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9193 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9194 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9196 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9198 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9199 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9200 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9201 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9204 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9206 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9210 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9211 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9212 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9213 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9214 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9215 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9216 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9217 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9219 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9220 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9221 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9222 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9223 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9226 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9227 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9228 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9230 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9231 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9234 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9235 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9236 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9237 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9238 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9239 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9240 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9241 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9243 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9244 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9245 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9246 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9247 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9248 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9249 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9250 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9251 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9252 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9254 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9255 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9256 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9257 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9259 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9260 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9261 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9262 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9263 is the expansion of the third argument.
9265 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9266 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9267 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9269 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9270 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9271 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9272 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9273 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9274 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9275 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9276 newlines are left in the string.
9277 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9278 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9279 the string expansion fails.
9281 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9282 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9286 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9287 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9288 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9289 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9290 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9291 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or Internet socket into the expanded
9292 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9295 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9296 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9298 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9299 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9300 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9301 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9302 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9305 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9307 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9308 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9309 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9310 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9311 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9312 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9314 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9316 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9317 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9318 turns them into spaces:
9320 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9322 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9323 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9324 addition, the following errors can occur:
9327 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9329 Failure to connect the socket;
9331 Failure to write the request string;
9333 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9336 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9337 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9338 errors occurs. For example:
9340 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9343 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9344 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9345 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9346 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9347 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9349 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9350 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9353 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9354 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9355 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9358 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9359 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9360 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9361 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9362 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9363 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9364 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9365 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9366 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9368 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9370 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9373 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9375 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9376 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9379 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9380 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9381 expansion item above.
9383 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9384 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9385 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9386 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9387 The command and its arguments are first expanded separately, and then the
9388 command is run in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in
9389 other command executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If you want
9390 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9392 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9393 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9394 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9396 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9397 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9398 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9399 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9400 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9403 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9404 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9405 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9406 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9409 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9410 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9412 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9413 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9417 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9418 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9421 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9422 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9423 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9424 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9426 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9427 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9430 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9431 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9432 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9433 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9434 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9435 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9436 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9437 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9439 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9441 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9442 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9443 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9445 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9447 yields &"defabc"&, and
9449 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9451 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9452 the regular expression from string expansion.
9456 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9457 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9458 .cindex "substring extraction"
9459 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9460 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9461 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9462 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9463 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9465 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9467 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9468 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9471 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9472 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9473 length required. For example
9475 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9477 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9478 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9479 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9480 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9482 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9483 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9484 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9486 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9488 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9489 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9490 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9492 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9494 yields an empty string, but
9496 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9500 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9501 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9502 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9503 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9506 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9508 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9512 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9513 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9514 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9515 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9516 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9517 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9518 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9519 replacement list. For example
9521 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9523 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9524 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9525 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9531 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9532 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9533 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9534 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9535 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9536 following operations can be performed:
9539 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9540 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9541 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9542 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9543 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9544 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9547 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9548 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9549 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9550 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9551 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9552 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9553 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9554 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9555 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9557 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9558 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9559 character. For example:
9561 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9563 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9564 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9565 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9569 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9570 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9571 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9572 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9573 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9574 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9575 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9576 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9577 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9579 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9580 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9581 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9582 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9583 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9584 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9588 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9589 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9590 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9591 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9592 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9595 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9596 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9597 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9598 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9599 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9600 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9601 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9604 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9605 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9606 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9607 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9608 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9609 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9610 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9611 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9612 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9613 C programming language):
9615 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9616 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9617 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9618 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9621 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9623 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9624 space is permitted before or after operators.
9626 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9627 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9628 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9629 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9630 times, which often do have leading zeros.
9632 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
9634 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
9635 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
9638 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
9639 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
9640 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
9641 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
9642 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
9643 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
9644 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
9645 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
9646 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
9647 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
9648 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
9651 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
9653 deny message = Too many bad recipients
9656 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
9659 {$recipients_count} \
9660 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
9664 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
9665 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
9668 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9669 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
9670 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
9673 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
9675 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
9676 and then re-expands what it has found.
9679 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9681 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
9682 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
9683 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
9684 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
9685 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
9686 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
9687 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
9688 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
9689 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
9691 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
9692 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
9693 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
9694 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
9695 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
9696 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
9697 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
9700 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9701 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9702 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9703 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
9704 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
9705 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9707 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9709 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
9710 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
9714 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
9715 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
9716 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
9717 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
9718 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
9719 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
9722 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9723 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9724 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9725 .cindex "lower casing"
9726 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9727 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
9728 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
9733 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9734 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9735 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9736 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
9737 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
9738 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
9740 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
9742 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
9743 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
9744 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
9747 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9748 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
9749 .cindex "list" "item count"
9750 .cindex "list" "count of items"
9751 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
9752 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
9755 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${list_*&<&'type'&>&*name'&>&*}*&
9756 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
9757 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
9758 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
9759 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
9760 If the optional type if given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
9761 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
9762 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
9763 matching list is returned.
9766 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9767 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
9768 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
9769 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
9770 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
9774 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
9775 .cindex "masked IP address"
9776 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
9777 .cindex "CIDR notation"
9778 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
9779 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
9780 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
9781 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
9782 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
9783 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
9784 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
9786 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
9788 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
9789 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
9790 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
9791 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
9793 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
9797 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
9799 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
9802 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9804 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
9805 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
9806 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
9807 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
9810 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9811 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9812 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9813 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
9814 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
9815 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9817 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9819 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
9822 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9823 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
9824 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
9825 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
9826 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
9827 is an empty string or
9828 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
9829 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
9830 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
9831 respectively For example,
9839 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
9840 variable or a message header.
9842 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9843 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
9844 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
9845 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
9846 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
9847 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
9848 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
9851 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9852 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
9853 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
9854 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
9855 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
9857 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
9863 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
9864 yields an unchanged string.
9867 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
9868 .cindex "random number"
9869 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
9870 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
9871 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
9872 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
9873 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
9874 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
9875 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
9876 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
9880 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
9881 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
9882 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
9883 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addreses the result is in
9884 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
9885 for DNS. For example,
9887 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
9888 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.3}
9893 3.0.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
9897 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9898 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9899 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
9900 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
9901 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
9902 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
9903 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
9904 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
9905 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
9908 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
9910 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
9911 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
9915 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9916 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9917 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
9918 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
9919 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
9920 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
9921 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
9922 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
9924 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
9925 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
9926 to use this operator as well.
9930 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9931 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
9932 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
9933 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
9934 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
9935 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
9936 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
9939 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9940 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
9941 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
9942 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
9943 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
9944 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
9947 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9948 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
9949 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
9950 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
9951 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
9952 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
9953 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
9954 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
9955 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
9956 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
9957 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
9958 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
9959 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
9961 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
9962 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
9963 systems for files larger than 2GB.
9965 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9966 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
9967 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
9968 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
9969 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
9973 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9974 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
9975 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
9976 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
9977 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
9978 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
9981 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9982 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9983 .cindex "substring extraction"
9984 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
9985 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
9986 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
9987 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9989 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
9991 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
9992 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
9994 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9995 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
9996 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
9997 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10000 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10001 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10002 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10003 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10004 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10005 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10008 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10009 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10010 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10011 .cindex "upper casing"
10012 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10013 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10014 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10022 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10023 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10024 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10025 while expanding strings:
10028 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10029 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10030 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10031 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10034 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10035 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10036 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10037 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10043 &`>= `& greater or equal
10045 &`<= `& less or equal
10049 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10051 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10052 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10053 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10054 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10055 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10058 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10059 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10060 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10063 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10064 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10065 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10066 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10067 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10068 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10069 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10070 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10071 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10072 are overwritten. If the ACL sets
10073 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10074 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10075 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10076 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10078 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10079 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10080 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10081 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10082 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10083 (case-insensitively); also positive integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10085 An empty string is treated as false.
10086 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10087 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10088 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10090 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10091 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10094 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10098 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10099 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10100 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10101 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10102 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10103 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10104 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10105 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10107 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10109 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10110 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10111 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10112 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10113 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10114 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10115 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10116 included in the binary.
10118 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10119 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10120 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10121 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10122 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10123 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10124 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10125 string in LDAP form is:
10127 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10129 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10130 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10132 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10134 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10139 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10140 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10141 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10142 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10143 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10144 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10148 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10149 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10150 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10151 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10152 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10153 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10156 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10157 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10158 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10159 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10160 whatever its length.
10163 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10164 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10165 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10166 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10168 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10169 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10170 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10171 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10172 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10173 support &[crypt16()]&.
10175 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10176 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10177 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10178 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10179 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10181 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10182 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10183 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10185 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10186 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10187 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10188 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10189 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10191 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10192 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10193 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10194 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10195 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10196 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10198 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10200 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10201 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10203 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10204 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10205 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10206 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10207 exists in the message. For example,
10209 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10211 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10212 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10214 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10215 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10216 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10217 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10218 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10219 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10220 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10221 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10222 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10224 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10225 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10226 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10227 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10228 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10229 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10230 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10231 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10233 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10234 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10235 .cindex "first delivery"
10236 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10237 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10238 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10239 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10242 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10243 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10244 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10245 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10246 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10248 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10249 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10250 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10251 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10252 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10254 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10255 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10256 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10258 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10259 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10260 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10262 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10263 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10264 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10265 list separator is changed to a comma:
10267 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10269 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10270 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10273 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10274 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10275 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10276 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10277 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10278 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10279 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10280 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10281 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10284 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10285 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10286 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10287 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10288 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10289 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10290 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10291 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10292 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10295 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10296 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10297 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10298 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10299 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10300 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10303 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10304 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10306 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10307 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10308 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10309 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10312 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10313 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10314 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10315 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10316 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10317 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10318 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10319 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10320 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10321 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10322 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10324 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10325 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10326 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10327 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10328 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10330 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10331 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10332 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10333 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10335 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10337 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10339 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10340 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10341 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10342 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10343 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10344 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10345 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10346 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10347 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10348 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10349 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10350 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10351 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10355 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10356 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10357 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10358 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10359 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10360 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10361 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10362 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10363 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10366 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10367 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10368 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10369 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10370 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10371 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10372 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10373 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10374 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10378 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10379 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10380 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10381 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10382 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10383 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10384 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10385 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10386 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10387 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10388 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10391 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10393 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10394 backslashes is also required.
10396 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10397 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10398 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10399 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10400 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10401 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10403 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10404 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10405 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10406 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10407 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10408 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10409 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10410 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10412 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10413 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10414 See &*match_local_part*&.
10416 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10417 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10418 See &*match_local_part*&.
10420 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10421 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10422 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10423 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10424 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10425 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10427 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10429 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10432 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10434 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10436 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10437 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10438 in a single test such as
10439 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10440 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10441 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10442 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10444 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10446 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10448 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10450 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10451 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10452 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10453 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10454 masks. For example:
10456 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10458 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10459 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10460 address mask, for example:
10462 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10464 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10465 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10467 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10471 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10472 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10474 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10476 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10477 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10478 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10479 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10480 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10481 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10482 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10483 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10486 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10488 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10489 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10490 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10491 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10493 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10495 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10496 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10497 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10498 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10501 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10502 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10504 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10505 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10506 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10507 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10509 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10510 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10511 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10512 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10513 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10514 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10515 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10516 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10517 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10518 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10519 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10523 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10524 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10526 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10527 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10528 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10529 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10530 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10531 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10532 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10534 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10535 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10536 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10537 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10538 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10540 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10542 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10544 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10546 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10547 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10548 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10549 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10550 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10551 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10552 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10553 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10556 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10557 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10559 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10560 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10561 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10562 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10563 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10564 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10566 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10567 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10568 building Exim. For example:
10570 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10572 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10573 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10574 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10575 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10577 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10578 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10579 configuration, you might have this:
10581 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10583 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
10585 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
10587 .vitem &*queue_running*&
10588 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10589 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10590 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10591 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10592 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10595 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10597 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10598 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
10599 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
10600 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
10601 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
10604 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
10605 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
10606 this library, you need to set
10608 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
10610 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
10611 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
10613 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
10615 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
10616 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
10617 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
10619 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
10620 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
10621 the authentication is successful. For example:
10623 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
10627 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
10628 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
10629 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
10631 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
10632 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
10633 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
10634 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
10635 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
10636 by a process that is not running as root.
10638 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10639 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10640 building Exim. For example:
10642 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
10644 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10645 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10646 from the Cyrus SASL library.
10648 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
10649 two are mandatory. For example:
10651 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
10653 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
10654 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
10655 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
10660 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
10661 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
10662 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
10663 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
10664 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
10665 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
10666 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
10670 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10671 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
10672 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
10673 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10674 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
10677 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
10679 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
10680 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
10681 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
10683 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10684 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
10685 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
10686 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10687 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
10688 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
10689 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
10690 parsed but not evaluated.
10692 .ecindex IIDexpcond
10697 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
10698 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
10699 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
10700 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
10701 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
10704 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
10705 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
10706 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
10707 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
10708 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
10709 However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
10710 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
10711 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
10712 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
10713 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
10714 matching condition.
10716 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
10717 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
10718 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
10719 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
10720 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
10721 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
10722 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
10723 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
10724 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
10725 during subsequent delivery.
10727 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
10728 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
10729 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
10730 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
10731 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
10732 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
10733 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
10734 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
10737 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
10738 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
10739 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
10740 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
10741 be preserved by coding like this:
10743 warn !verify = sender
10744 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
10746 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
10747 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
10750 .vitem &$address_data$&
10751 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
10752 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
10753 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
10754 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
10755 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
10756 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
10759 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
10760 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
10761 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
10762 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
10763 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
10764 from the child's routing.
10766 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
10767 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
10768 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
10771 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
10772 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
10773 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
10775 .vitem &$address_file$&
10776 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
10777 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
10778 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
10779 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
10780 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
10782 /home/r2d2/savemail
10784 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
10785 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
10786 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
10787 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
10788 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
10789 to the relevant file.
10791 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
10792 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
10793 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
10794 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
10796 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
10797 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
10798 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
10799 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
10801 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
10802 .cindex "authentication" "id"
10803 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
10804 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
10805 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
10806 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
10807 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
10808 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
10809 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
10810 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
10811 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
10812 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
10813 command line option.
10818 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
10819 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
10820 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
10821 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
10822 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
10823 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
10824 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
10825 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
10826 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
10827 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
10828 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
10830 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
10831 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
10832 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
10833 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
10834 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
10837 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
10838 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
10839 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
10840 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
10841 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
10842 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
10843 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
10844 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
10845 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
10846 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
10847 an undefined mechanism.
10849 .vitem &$av_failed$&
10850 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
10851 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
10852 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
10853 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
10854 the ACL malware condition.
10856 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
10857 .cindex "message body" "line count"
10858 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
10859 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
10860 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10861 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
10863 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
10864 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
10865 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
10866 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
10867 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
10868 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10869 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
10871 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
10872 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
10873 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
10874 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
10875 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10877 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
10878 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
10879 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
10880 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
10881 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10883 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
10884 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
10885 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
10886 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10887 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
10888 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10889 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
10891 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
10892 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
10893 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
10894 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10895 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
10896 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10897 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
10899 .vitem &$compile_date$&
10900 .vindex "&$compile_date$&"
10901 The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
10903 .vitem &$compile_number$&
10904 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
10905 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
10906 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
10907 compilations of the same version of the program.
10909 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
10910 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
10911 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
10912 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
10913 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10915 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
10916 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
10917 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10918 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10919 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10921 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
10922 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
10923 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
10925 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
10926 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
10927 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
10928 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
10929 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
10930 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
10931 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
10932 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
10933 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
10936 .vindex "&$domain$&"
10937 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
10938 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
10939 case for &$domain$&.
10941 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
10942 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
10943 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
10944 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
10946 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
10947 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
10948 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
10949 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
10950 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
10951 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
10953 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
10954 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
10955 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
10957 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
10960 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
10961 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
10962 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
10963 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
10964 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
10965 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
10966 the &(smtp)& transport.
10969 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
10970 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
10971 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
10972 rewrite domains by file lookup.
10975 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
10976 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
10977 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
10978 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
10979 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
10980 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
10983 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
10984 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
10985 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
10986 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
10990 .vitem &$domain_data$&
10991 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
10992 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
10993 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
10994 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
10995 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
10996 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
10999 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11000 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11001 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11004 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11005 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11006 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11008 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11009 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11010 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11012 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11013 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11014 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11016 .vitem &$found_extension$&
11017 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
11018 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11019 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11020 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11022 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11023 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11024 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11025 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11026 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11030 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11031 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11032 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11033 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11034 by a setting on the transport itself.
11036 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11037 of the environment variable HOME.
11041 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11042 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11043 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11044 to local and remote transports.
11046 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11047 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11048 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11049 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11050 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11051 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11052 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11055 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11056 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11057 client is connected.
11060 .vitem &$host_address$&
11061 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11062 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11063 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11064 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11066 .vitem &$host_data$&
11067 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11068 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11069 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11070 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11072 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11073 message = $host_data
11075 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11076 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11077 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11078 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11079 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11080 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11081 variables is set to &"1"&.
11084 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11085 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11088 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11089 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11090 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11093 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11094 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11095 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11096 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11097 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11098 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11099 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11100 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11101 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11102 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11104 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11105 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11106 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11110 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11111 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11112 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11113 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11114 a unique name for the file.
11116 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11117 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11118 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11120 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11121 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11122 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11126 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11127 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11128 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11132 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11133 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11134 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11137 .vitem &$load_average$&
11138 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11139 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11140 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11141 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11143 .vitem &$local_part$&
11144 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11145 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11146 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11147 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11148 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11150 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11151 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11152 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11153 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11156 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11157 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11158 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11159 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11160 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11161 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11163 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11164 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11165 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11168 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11169 local part of the recipient address.
11171 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11172 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11173 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11175 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11178 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11179 abc\:xyz@test.example
11181 the value of &$local_part$& is
11185 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11186 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11189 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11191 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11192 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11193 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11195 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11196 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11197 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11198 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11199 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11200 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11201 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11203 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11204 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11205 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11206 variable expands to nothing.
11208 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11209 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11210 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11211 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11212 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11214 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11215 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11216 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11217 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11218 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11220 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11221 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11222 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11223 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11225 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11226 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11227 See &$local_user_uid$&.
11229 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11230 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11231 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11232 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11233 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11234 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11235 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11236 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11238 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
11239 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11240 This contains the expanded value of the
11241 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11244 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
11245 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11246 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11247 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11248 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11249 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11251 .vitem &$log_space$&
11252 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
11253 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11254 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11255 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11256 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11257 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11260 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11261 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11262 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11263 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11264 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11265 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11266 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11269 .vitem &$malware_name$&
11270 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11271 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11272 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11273 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11275 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11276 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11277 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
11278 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
11279 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11280 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11283 .vitem &$message_age$&
11284 .cindex "message" "age of"
11285 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
11286 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11287 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11290 .vitem &$message_body$&
11291 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11292 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11293 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11294 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
11295 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11296 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11297 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11298 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11299 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11301 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11302 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11303 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11304 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11305 zeros are always converted into spaces.
11307 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
11308 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11309 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11310 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11311 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11312 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11315 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
11316 .cindex "body of message" "size"
11317 .cindex "message body" "size"
11318 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11319 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11320 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11321 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11322 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11324 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11325 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11326 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11327 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11328 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11329 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11330 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11331 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11333 .vitem &$message_headers$&
11334 .vindex &$message_headers$&
11335 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11336 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11337 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11338 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11340 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11341 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11342 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11343 contents of header lines is done.
11345 .vitem &$message_id$&
11346 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&, which is now deprecated.
11348 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11349 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11350 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11351 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11352 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11353 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11354 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11355 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11356 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11357 from the body is not counted.
11359 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11360 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11361 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11362 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11363 header and the body).
11365 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11367 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11369 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11371 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11372 message has not yet been received.
11374 .vitem &$message_size$&
11375 .cindex "size" "of message"
11376 .cindex "message" "size"
11377 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11378 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11379 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11380 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11381 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11382 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11383 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11384 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11385 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11387 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11388 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11389 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11390 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11392 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11393 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11394 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11395 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11397 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11398 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11399 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11401 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11402 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11403 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11404 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11405 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11406 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11407 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11408 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11409 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11410 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11412 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11413 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11414 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11416 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11417 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11418 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11419 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11420 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11421 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11422 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11423 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11424 the original address.
11426 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11427 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11428 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11429 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11430 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11432 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11433 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11434 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11436 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11437 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11438 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11439 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11440 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11441 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11442 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11443 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11444 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11446 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11447 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11448 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11449 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11450 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11451 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11452 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11453 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11456 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11457 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11458 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11459 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11461 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11462 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11463 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11464 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11467 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11469 This variable contains the current process id.
11471 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11472 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11473 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11474 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11475 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11476 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11477 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11478 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11479 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11480 variable"& error if encountered.
11482 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11483 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11484 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11485 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11486 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11487 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11488 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11491 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11492 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11493 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11494 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11496 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11497 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11498 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11499 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11501 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11502 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11503 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11504 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11506 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11507 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11508 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11510 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11511 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
11512 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
11513 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
11515 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
11516 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
11517 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11518 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
11519 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
11521 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
11522 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
11523 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
11524 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11525 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11526 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
11528 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
11529 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
11530 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11531 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11532 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
11534 .vitem &$received_count$&
11535 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
11536 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
11537 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
11538 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
11541 .vitem &$received_for$&
11542 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
11543 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
11544 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
11545 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
11546 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
11548 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
11549 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
11550 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
11551 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
11552 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
11553 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
11554 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
11557 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
11558 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
11559 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
11560 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
11561 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
11564 &*Note:*& There are no equivalent variables for outgoing connections, because
11565 the values are unknown (unless they are explicitly set by options of the
11566 &(smtp)& transport).
11568 .vitem &$received_port$&
11569 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
11570 See &$received_ip_address$&.
11572 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
11573 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
11574 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
11575 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
11576 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
11577 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
11578 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
11579 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
11580 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
11582 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
11583 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
11584 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
11585 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
11586 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
11587 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
11589 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
11590 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
11591 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
11593 .vitem &$received_time$&
11594 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
11595 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
11596 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11598 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
11599 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
11600 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
11601 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
11602 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
11604 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11605 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
11607 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11608 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11609 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11610 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11612 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
11613 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
11614 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
11615 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
11618 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
11619 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
11622 &"route"&: Routing failed.
11625 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
11626 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
11630 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
11633 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
11636 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
11637 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
11639 .vitem &$recipients$&
11640 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
11641 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
11642 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
11643 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
11644 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
11648 In a system filter file.
11650 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
11651 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
11652 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
11653 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
11655 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
11659 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
11660 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
11661 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
11662 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
11663 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
11664 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
11667 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
11668 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
11669 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
11670 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
11673 .vitem &$reply_address$&
11674 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
11675 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
11676 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
11677 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
11678 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
11679 decoding or character code translation takes place.
11681 .vitem &$return_path$&
11682 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
11683 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
11684 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
11685 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
11686 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
11687 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
11688 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
11689 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
11690 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
11691 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
11694 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
11695 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
11696 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
11699 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
11700 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
11701 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
11702 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
11703 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
11704 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
11705 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
11708 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
11709 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
11710 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
11711 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
11712 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
11713 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
11714 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
11715 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
11717 .vitem &$sender_address$&
11718 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
11719 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
11720 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
11721 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
11722 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
11724 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
11725 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11726 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
11727 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11728 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
11729 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
11730 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
11731 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
11733 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
11734 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
11735 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
11737 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
11738 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
11739 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
11741 .vitem &$sender_data$&
11742 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
11743 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
11744 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
11745 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
11748 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11749 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
11751 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11752 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11753 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11754 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11756 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
11757 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
11758 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
11759 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
11760 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
11761 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
11762 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
11763 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
11764 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
11765 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
11766 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
11767 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
11768 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
11770 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
11771 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
11772 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
11773 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
11774 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
11775 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
11777 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
11778 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
11779 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains that
11780 host's IP address. For locally submitted messages, it is empty.
11782 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
11783 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
11784 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
11785 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
11786 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
11787 &$authenticated_id$&.
11790 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
11791 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
11792 If &$sender_host_name$& has been populated (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
11793 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
11794 resolver library states that the reverse DNS was authenticated data. At all
11795 other times, this variable is false.
11797 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
11798 library, by setting:
11803 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
11804 validating resolver (eg, unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
11806 Exim does not (currently) check to see if the forward DNS was also secured
11807 with DNSSEC, only the reverse DNS.
11809 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
11810 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
11814 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
11815 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
11816 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11817 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
11818 other means, this variable is empty.
11820 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11821 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
11822 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
11823 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
11824 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
11825 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
11826 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11828 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11829 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
11830 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
11831 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
11833 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
11834 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
11835 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11838 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
11839 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
11840 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
11841 following are true:
11844 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
11846 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
11847 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
11848 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
11850 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
11851 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
11852 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
11854 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
11855 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
11856 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
11858 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
11859 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
11860 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11861 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
11863 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
11865 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
11866 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
11870 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
11871 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
11872 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
11873 number that was used on the remote host.
11875 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
11876 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
11877 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11878 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
11879 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
11882 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
11883 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
11884 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
11885 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
11887 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
11888 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
11889 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
11890 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
11891 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
11892 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
11893 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
11894 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
11895 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
11896 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
11897 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
11900 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
11901 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
11902 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
11903 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
11904 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
11906 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
11907 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
11908 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
11909 about the failure. The details are the same as for
11910 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
11912 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
11913 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
11914 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11915 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
11916 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
11917 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
11918 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
11920 .vitem &$sending_port$&
11921 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
11922 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11923 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
11924 connections, see &$received_port$&.
11926 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
11927 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
11928 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
11929 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
11930 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
11931 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
11933 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
11934 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
11935 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
11936 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
11937 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
11942 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
11943 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
11944 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
11945 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
11947 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
11948 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
11949 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
11950 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
11951 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
11952 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
11953 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
11955 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
11956 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
11957 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
11958 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
11959 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
11960 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
11961 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
11962 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
11963 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
11964 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
11965 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
11967 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
11968 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
11969 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
11970 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
11971 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
11972 message is junk mail.
11974 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
11975 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
11976 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
11977 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
11980 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
11981 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
11982 The name of Exim's spool directory.
11984 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
11985 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
11986 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
11987 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
11988 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
11989 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
11991 .vitem &$spool_space$&
11992 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
11993 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
11994 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
11995 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
11996 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
11997 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
11998 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12000 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12002 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12005 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12006 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12007 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12008 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12009 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12010 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12012 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12013 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12014 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12015 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12016 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12017 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12018 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12019 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12021 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12022 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12025 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12026 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12027 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12028 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12029 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12030 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12032 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12033 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12034 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12035 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12037 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verfied$& variable refers to the inbound side
12038 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12041 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12042 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12043 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12044 outbound SMTP connection was made,
12045 and &"0"& otherwise.
12047 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12048 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12049 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12050 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12051 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12052 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12053 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12054 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12055 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12057 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12058 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12059 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12061 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12062 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12064 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12065 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12066 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12067 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12069 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12070 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12071 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12072 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12073 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12074 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12075 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12077 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12078 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12081 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12082 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12083 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12084 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12085 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12086 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12088 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12089 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12090 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12091 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12092 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12093 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12094 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12095 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12096 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12097 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12098 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12100 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12101 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12104 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
12105 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
12106 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12108 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12111 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12112 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12113 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12114 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
12116 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
12117 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
12118 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12120 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
12121 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
12122 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12124 .vitem &$tod_full$&
12125 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
12126 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
12127 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
12128 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
12129 values for those that are behind (west).
12132 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
12133 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
12134 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
12136 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
12137 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
12138 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
12139 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
12142 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
12143 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
12144 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
12147 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
12148 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
12149 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
12150 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
12153 .vindex "&$value$&"
12154 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
12155 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
12156 &*reduce*& expansion.
12158 .vitem &$version_number$&
12159 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
12160 The version number of Exim.
12162 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12163 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12164 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12165 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12167 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12168 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12169 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12170 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12176 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12177 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12179 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12180 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12181 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12182 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12183 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12184 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12189 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12192 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12193 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12194 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12195 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12196 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12197 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12198 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12199 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12200 a newly created Perl interpreter.
12202 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12203 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12204 should usually be something like
12206 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12208 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12209 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12210 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12211 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12212 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12213 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12214 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12215 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12219 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12220 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12221 a startup when Exim is entered.
12223 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12224 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12227 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12228 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12231 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12232 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12233 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12234 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12238 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
12239 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12241 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12242 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12243 with an error message of the form
12245 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12247 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12248 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12249 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12250 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12251 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12252 that was passed to &%die%&.
12255 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12256 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12257 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12260 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
12262 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
12263 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
12264 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
12266 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
12267 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
12268 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
12269 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
12271 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
12272 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
12273 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
12274 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
12275 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
12276 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
12277 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
12280 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
12281 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
12282 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
12283 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
12284 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
12285 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
12286 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
12287 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
12288 avoided, but the output is lost.
12290 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
12291 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
12292 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
12293 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
12294 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
12295 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
12296 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
12298 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
12300 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
12301 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
12302 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
12303 as the first subroutine argument.
12307 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12308 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12310 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
12311 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
12312 "Starting the daemon"
12313 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
12314 .cindex "interface" "listening"
12315 .cindex "network interface"
12316 .cindex "interface" "network"
12317 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
12318 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
12319 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
12320 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12321 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
12322 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
12323 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
12324 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
12325 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
12326 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
12327 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
12330 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
12331 and ports to listen on.
12333 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12334 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12335 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12336 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12337 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12338 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12339 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12340 as an error situation.
12342 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12343 for the outgoing connection.
12347 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12348 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12349 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12350 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12351 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12353 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12354 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12355 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
12356 chapter describes how they operate.
12358 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
12359 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12363 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
12364 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
12365 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
12369 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports. (For backward
12370 compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
12372 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
12373 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
12376 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
12377 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
12378 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
12379 colons. For example:
12381 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
12384 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
12386 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
12387 in &%local_interfaces%&:
12390 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
12391 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
12393 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
12394 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
12397 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
12398 with a colon separator, for example:
12400 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
12401 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
12405 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
12406 default setting contains just one port:
12408 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12410 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
12411 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
12412 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
12413 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
12414 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
12418 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
12419 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
12420 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
12421 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
12422 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
12423 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12425 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
12427 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
12429 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12431 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
12435 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
12436 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
12437 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
12438 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
12439 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
12440 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
12443 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
12444 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
12445 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
12446 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
12447 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12448 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
12452 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
12455 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
12457 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
12458 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
12459 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
12463 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
12464 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
12465 .cindex "smtps protocol"
12466 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
12467 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
12468 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
12469 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
12470 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
12471 list of port numbers, connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
12472 common use of this option is expected to be
12474 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
12476 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
12477 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
12478 this way when a daemon is started.
12480 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
12481 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
12482 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
12483 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
12484 connections via the daemon.)
12489 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
12490 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
12491 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
12492 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
12493 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
12494 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
12495 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
12496 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
12498 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
12500 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
12501 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
12502 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
12503 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
12504 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
12505 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
12507 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
12509 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
12510 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
12511 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
12512 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
12513 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
12515 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
12516 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
12517 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
12518 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
12519 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
12520 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
12521 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
12522 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
12523 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
12524 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
12525 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
12526 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
12528 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
12529 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
12530 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
12531 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
12532 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
12536 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
12537 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
12539 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12540 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12542 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
12543 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
12544 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
12545 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
12547 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
12549 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
12551 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
12553 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
12554 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
12556 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
12557 IPv4 loopback address only:
12559 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
12561 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
12563 local_interfaces = 192.168.34.67 : 192.168.34.67
12565 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
12569 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
12570 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
12571 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
12572 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
12575 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
12576 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
12577 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
12578 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
12580 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
12581 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
12582 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
12583 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
12584 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
12585 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
12586 used for listening. Consider this example:
12588 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
12590 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
12592 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12594 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
12595 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
12598 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
12599 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
12600 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
12601 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
12602 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
12603 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
12604 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
12605 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
12609 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
12610 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
12611 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
12612 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
12613 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
12614 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
12620 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12621 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12623 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
12624 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
12625 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
12626 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
12629 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
12630 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
12632 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
12633 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
12634 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
12636 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
12637 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
12638 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
12639 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
12643 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
12644 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
12645 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
12646 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
12647 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
12648 listed in more than one group.
12650 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
12652 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
12653 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12654 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
12655 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
12656 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
12657 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
12658 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
12659 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
12660 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
12664 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
12666 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
12667 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12668 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
12669 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
12670 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
12671 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
12676 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
12678 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
12679 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
12680 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
12681 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12682 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12683 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
12684 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
12685 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
12686 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
12687 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
12688 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
12693 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
12695 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
12696 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12697 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
12698 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
12699 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
12700 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
12701 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
12702 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
12703 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
12704 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
12705 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
12706 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
12711 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
12713 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
12714 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
12715 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
12716 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
12721 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
12723 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
12724 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
12725 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
12726 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
12727 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
12728 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
12729 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
12730 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
12731 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
12732 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
12733 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
12734 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
12735 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
12736 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
12737 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
12742 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
12744 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
12745 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
12750 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
12752 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
12753 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
12758 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
12760 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
12761 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
12762 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
12763 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
12764 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
12765 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12766 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12771 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
12773 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12774 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
12775 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12776 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
12777 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
12778 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
12779 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12780 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12781 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12782 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12783 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12784 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12785 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12786 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12787 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12788 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12790 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12791 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12792 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12793 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
12794 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12799 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
12801 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
12802 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
12803 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
12804 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
12805 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
12806 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
12807 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
12808 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
12809 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
12810 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
12811 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
12812 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
12813 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
12814 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
12815 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
12816 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
12817 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
12818 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
12819 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
12820 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12822 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
12823 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
12824 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12825 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12826 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
12827 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
12828 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
12829 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
12830 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
12831 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12832 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12833 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
12834 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
12835 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
12836 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
12837 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12838 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
12839 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
12844 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
12846 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
12848 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
12850 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
12851 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
12852 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
12857 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
12859 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
12861 .row &%gnutls_enable_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
12863 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
12864 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12865 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
12866 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
12867 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
12868 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
12869 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
12870 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
12871 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
12872 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
12873 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
12874 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
12875 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
12880 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
12882 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
12883 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
12884 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
12885 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
12886 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
12887 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
12888 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
12889 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
12894 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
12896 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12897 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12898 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
12899 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12900 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
12901 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
12902 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
12903 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
12909 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
12911 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
12918 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
12919 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
12922 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12923 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12924 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
12925 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
12926 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
12927 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
12928 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
12929 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12930 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12931 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12932 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12933 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12934 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12935 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12937 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12938 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
12939 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
12940 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12941 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12942 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
12943 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
12944 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
12945 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
12946 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
12947 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
12948 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
12949 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
12950 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
12951 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12952 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12957 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
12959 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
12960 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
12961 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
12962 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
12963 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
12964 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12969 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
12971 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
12972 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
12973 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
12974 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12976 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12977 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12978 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
12979 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
12980 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
12981 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
12982 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12983 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
12984 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
12985 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
12990 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
12992 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
12993 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
12995 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
12996 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
12997 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
12998 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
12999 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13004 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13006 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13007 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13008 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13009 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13010 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13011 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13013 .row &%dns_use_dnssec%& "parameter for resolver"
13015 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13016 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13017 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13018 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13019 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13020 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13021 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13022 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13023 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13024 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13025 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13026 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13027 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13028 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13029 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13030 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13035 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13037 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13038 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13039 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13040 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13041 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13042 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13043 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13044 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13045 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13046 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13047 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13048 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13049 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13050 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13055 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13056 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13059 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13061 .cindex "8-bit characters"
13062 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
13063 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
13064 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
13065 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
13067 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
13068 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
13069 It now defaults to true.
13070 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
13072 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
13075 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
13076 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
13077 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13078 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
13079 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13082 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13083 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
13084 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
13087 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
13088 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
13089 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13090 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
13091 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13093 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
13094 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
13095 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
13096 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
13097 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13099 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
13100 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
13101 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
13102 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13104 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
13105 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13106 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
13107 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
13108 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13110 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
13111 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
13112 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
13113 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13115 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
13116 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
13117 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
13118 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13120 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
13121 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
13122 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
13123 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
13124 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13127 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
13128 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
13129 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
13130 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13132 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
13133 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
13134 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
13135 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
13136 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
13138 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13139 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
13140 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
13141 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
13142 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
13144 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
13145 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
13146 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13149 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
13150 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
13151 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
13152 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13154 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
13155 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
13156 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
13157 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13159 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
13160 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
13161 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
13162 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13164 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
13165 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
13166 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
13167 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13169 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
13170 .cindex "admin user"
13171 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13172 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13173 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13174 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13175 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13176 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13177 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13179 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13180 .cindex "domain literal"
13181 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13182 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13183 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13184 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13186 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13187 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13188 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13189 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13190 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13191 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13192 the local host's IP addresses.
13195 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13196 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13197 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13198 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13199 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13200 that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
13201 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13202 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13203 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13205 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
13206 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
13207 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
13208 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
13209 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
13210 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
13211 experiment if they wish.
13213 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
13214 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
13215 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
13216 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
13217 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
13218 suitable setting is:
13220 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
13221 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
13223 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
13225 dns_check_names_pattern =
13227 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
13230 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
13231 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
13232 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
13233 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
13234 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
13235 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
13236 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
13237 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
13238 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
13239 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
13240 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
13242 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
13243 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
13244 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
13245 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
13246 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
13247 which Exim advertises AUTH.
13249 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
13250 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
13251 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
13252 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
13254 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
13256 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13257 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
13258 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
13259 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
13262 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
13263 .cindex "thawing messages"
13264 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
13265 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
13266 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
13267 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
13268 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
13269 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
13271 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
13272 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
13273 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
13276 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
13277 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
13278 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
13280 sophie:/var/run/sophie
13282 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
13283 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
13286 .option bi_command main string unset
13288 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
13289 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
13290 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
13291 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
13294 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
13295 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
13296 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
13297 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13298 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
13299 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
13302 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
13303 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
13304 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
13305 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
13307 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
13308 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
13309 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
13310 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
13311 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
13312 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
13313 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
13314 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
13315 point at which the error was detected are returned.
13316 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
13318 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
13319 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
13320 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
13321 &%bounce_return_body%&.
13324 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
13325 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
13326 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
13327 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
13328 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
13329 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
13330 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
13331 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
13332 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
13334 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
13335 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
13336 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
13337 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
13338 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
13341 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
13342 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
13343 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
13344 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
13345 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
13346 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
13347 connection. A typical setting might be:
13349 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13351 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
13353 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13355 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
13358 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
13359 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
13360 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
13361 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
13362 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13363 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13366 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
13367 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
13368 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13369 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13372 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
13373 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
13374 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13375 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13378 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
13379 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
13380 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13381 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13384 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
13385 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
13386 callout verification. The default value is
13388 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
13390 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
13393 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
13394 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13397 .option check_log_space main integer 0
13398 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13400 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
13401 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
13402 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
13403 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
13404 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
13405 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
13406 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
13407 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
13408 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
13409 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
13412 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
13413 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13416 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
13417 .cindex "checking disk space"
13418 .cindex "disk space, checking"
13419 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
13420 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
13421 message is accepted.
13423 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
13424 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
13425 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13426 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13427 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
13428 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
13429 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
13430 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
13433 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
13434 either value is greater than zero, for example:
13436 check_spool_space = 10M
13437 check_spool_inodes = 100
13439 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
13440 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
13443 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
13444 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
13445 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
13447 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
13448 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
13449 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
13450 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
13451 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
13452 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
13454 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
13455 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
13457 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
13458 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
13459 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
13461 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
13462 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
13463 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13464 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
13465 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
13466 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
13468 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
13469 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
13470 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
13471 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
13472 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
13473 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
13474 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
13476 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
13477 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
13479 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
13480 .cindex "warning of delay"
13481 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
13482 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
13483 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
13484 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
13485 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
13486 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
13487 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
13490 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
13492 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
13493 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
13494 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
13495 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
13499 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
13500 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
13502 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
13505 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
13506 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13507 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
13508 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
13509 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
13510 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
13511 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
13512 not sent. The default is:
13514 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
13515 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
13516 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
13517 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
13520 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
13521 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
13522 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
13523 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
13525 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
13526 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
13527 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
13528 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
13529 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
13530 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
13531 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
13532 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
13534 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
13535 .cindex "load average"
13536 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
13537 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
13538 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
13539 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
13540 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
13543 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
13544 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
13545 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
13546 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13547 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
13548 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
13549 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
13550 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13552 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
13553 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
13554 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
13555 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
13556 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
13557 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
13558 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
13559 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
13561 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
13562 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
13563 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
13564 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
13567 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
13568 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13569 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13570 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13571 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
13572 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13573 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13576 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
13577 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
13578 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
13579 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
13580 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
13581 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
13582 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
13583 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
13584 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
13585 by a setting such as this:
13587 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
13589 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
13590 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
13591 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
13592 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
13593 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
13594 options are applied after this global option.
13596 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
13597 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
13598 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
13599 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
13600 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
13601 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
13602 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
13603 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
13604 value of this option. The default pattern is
13606 dns_check_names_pattern = \
13607 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
13609 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
13610 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
13611 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
13612 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
13613 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
13616 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
13617 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
13618 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13620 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
13621 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
13622 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
13623 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13625 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
13626 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
13627 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
13628 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
13629 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
13630 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
13631 domain matches this list.
13633 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
13634 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
13635 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
13638 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
13639 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13640 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
13641 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
13642 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
13643 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
13644 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
13645 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
13646 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
13647 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
13651 .option dns_retry main integer 0
13652 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
13656 .option dns_use_dnssec main integer -1
13657 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13658 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13659 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
13660 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
13661 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
13663 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
13667 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
13668 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13669 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
13670 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
13671 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
13672 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
13675 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
13678 .option drop_cr main boolean false
13679 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
13680 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
13681 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
13683 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
13684 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
13685 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
13686 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
13687 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
13688 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
13690 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
13692 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
13693 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
13695 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
13696 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
13697 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
13698 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13699 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
13700 messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
13701 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
13702 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
13703 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13706 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
13707 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
13708 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
13709 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
13710 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
13711 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
13712 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
13713 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
13714 must be enclosed in double quotes.
13716 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
13717 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
13718 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
13719 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
13720 are examined. For example:
13722 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
13723 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
13724 postmaster@mydomain.example
13726 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13727 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13728 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
13729 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
13730 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
13731 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
13732 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
13735 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
13736 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
13737 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
13739 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
13741 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
13742 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
13743 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
13744 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
13745 overrides the default.
13747 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
13748 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
13749 and warning messages. For example:
13751 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
13753 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
13754 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
13755 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
13756 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
13760 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
13761 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
13762 .cindex "Exim group"
13763 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13764 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
13765 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
13766 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
13767 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
13771 .option exim_path main string "see below"
13772 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
13773 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
13774 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
13775 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
13776 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
13778 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
13779 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
13780 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
13781 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
13784 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
13785 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
13786 .cindex "Exim user"
13787 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13788 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
13789 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
13790 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
13792 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
13793 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
13794 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
13795 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
13798 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
13799 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
13800 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
13801 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
13804 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
13805 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
13807 .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
13808 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
13810 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
13811 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
13812 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
13813 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
13814 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
13815 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
13816 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
13817 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
13818 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
13819 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
13823 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
13824 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
13825 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
13826 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
13827 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
13828 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
13829 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
13830 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
13833 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
13834 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
13835 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
13836 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
13840 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
13841 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
13842 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
13843 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
13844 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
13845 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
13846 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
13847 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
13848 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
13849 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
13850 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
13851 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
13852 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
13853 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
13854 logging that you require.
13857 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
13859 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
13860 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
13861 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
13862 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
13863 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
13864 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
13865 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
13866 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
13868 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
13869 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
13870 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
13873 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
13874 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
13875 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
13876 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
13878 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
13882 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
13883 See &%gecos_name%& above.
13886 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
13887 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
13888 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
13889 implementations of TLS.
13893 option gnutls_enable_pkcs11 main boolean unset
13894 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
13895 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
13898 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
13904 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
13905 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
13906 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
13907 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
13908 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
13909 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
13913 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
13914 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
13915 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
13916 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
13917 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
13918 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
13919 sections are rejected.
13922 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
13923 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
13924 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
13925 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
13926 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
13927 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
13928 zero means &"no limit"&.
13933 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13934 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
13935 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
13936 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
13937 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
13938 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
13939 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
13940 if you want to do semantic checking.
13941 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
13945 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
13946 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
13947 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
13948 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
13949 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
13950 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
13951 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
13953 helo_allow_chars = _
13955 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
13958 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
13959 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13960 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13961 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
13962 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
13963 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
13964 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
13968 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13969 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
13970 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
13971 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
13972 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
13973 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
13974 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
13975 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
13976 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
13977 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
13978 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
13979 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
13981 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
13982 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
13983 EHLO command either:
13986 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
13988 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13989 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13990 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
13991 calling host address, or
13993 when looked up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when
13994 available) yields the calling host address.
13997 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
13998 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
13999 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
14001 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14002 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
14003 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
14004 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
14005 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
14006 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
14007 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
14008 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
14009 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
14012 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14013 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
14014 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
14015 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
14016 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
14017 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
14018 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
14019 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
14020 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
14022 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
14023 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
14024 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
14025 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
14026 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
14028 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
14029 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
14030 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
14031 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
14034 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
14035 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
14036 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
14037 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
14038 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
14039 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
14040 default configuration file contains
14044 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
14045 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
14047 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
14048 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
14049 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
14051 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
14052 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
14053 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
14054 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
14055 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
14056 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
14059 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
14060 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
14061 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
14062 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
14063 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
14066 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
14067 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
14068 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
14069 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
14073 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
14074 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
14075 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
14076 as soon as the connection is made.
14077 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
14078 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
14079 connections immediately.
14081 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
14082 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
14083 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
14084 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
14085 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
14088 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
14089 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
14090 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
14091 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
14092 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
14093 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
14094 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
14095 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
14096 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
14098 hosts_connection_nolog = :
14100 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
14104 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
14105 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
14106 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
14107 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
14108 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
14110 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
14111 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
14113 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
14114 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
14115 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
14116 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
14117 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
14118 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
14119 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
14122 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
14123 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
14124 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
14125 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14126 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
14130 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
14131 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
14132 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
14133 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
14134 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
14135 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
14137 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
14138 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
14139 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
14140 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
14141 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
14142 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
14143 for frozen messages. For example,
14145 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
14147 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
14148 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
14149 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
14150 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
14151 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
14152 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
14155 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14156 .cindex "&""From""& line"
14157 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
14158 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
14159 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
14160 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
14161 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
14162 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
14163 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
14164 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
14167 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
14168 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
14171 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
14172 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
14173 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
14174 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
14178 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
14179 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
14180 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
14181 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14182 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14183 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14184 and constrained to be a directory.
14187 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
14188 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
14189 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
14190 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14191 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14192 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14193 and constrained to be a file.
14196 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
14197 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
14198 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
14199 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14200 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
14203 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
14204 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
14205 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
14206 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14207 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
14208 identity to be proven.
14211 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
14212 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
14213 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
14214 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
14215 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
14218 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
14219 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
14220 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
14221 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
14222 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
14226 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
14227 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
14228 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
14229 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
14230 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
14231 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
14235 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
14236 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
14237 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
14238 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
14239 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
14241 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
14242 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
14245 .option ldap_version main integer unset
14246 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
14247 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
14248 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
14249 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
14250 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
14251 has been built with LDAP support.
14255 .option local_from_check main boolean true
14256 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
14257 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
14258 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14259 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
14260 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
14261 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
14263 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
14264 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
14265 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14267 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
14268 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
14269 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
14270 and the default qualify domain.
14272 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
14273 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
14274 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
14275 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
14277 .cindex "envelope sender"
14278 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
14279 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
14280 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
14282 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
14283 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
14284 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14289 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
14290 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
14291 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
14292 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
14293 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
14294 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
14295 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
14298 local_from_prefix = *-
14300 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
14302 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
14304 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
14305 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
14309 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
14310 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
14313 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
14314 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
14315 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
14316 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
14317 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
14318 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
14319 &%local_interfaces%& is
14321 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14323 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
14325 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14328 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
14329 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
14330 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
14331 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
14332 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
14333 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
14334 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
14335 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
14339 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
14340 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
14341 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14342 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
14343 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
14344 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
14345 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
14346 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14351 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
14352 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
14353 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
14354 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
14355 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
14356 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
14357 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
14358 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
14359 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
14360 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
14361 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
14362 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
14363 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
14364 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
14365 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
14369 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
14370 .cindex "log" "file path for"
14371 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
14372 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
14373 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
14374 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
14375 are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
14376 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
14377 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
14378 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
14379 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
14380 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
14381 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
14382 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
14385 .option log_selector main string unset
14386 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14387 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
14388 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
14389 minus characters. For example:
14391 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
14393 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
14394 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
14397 .option log_timezone main boolean false
14398 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
14399 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
14400 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
14401 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
14402 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
14403 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
14404 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
14405 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
14406 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
14407 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
14408 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
14409 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
14412 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
14413 .cindex "too many open files"
14414 .cindex "open files, too many"
14415 .cindex "file" "too many open"
14416 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
14417 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
14418 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
14419 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
14420 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
14421 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
14422 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
14423 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
14424 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
14425 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
14426 &%lookup_open_max%&.
14429 .option max_username_length main integer 0
14430 .cindex "length of login name"
14431 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
14432 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
14433 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
14434 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
14435 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
14436 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
14439 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
14440 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
14441 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
14442 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
14443 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14444 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
14445 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
14446 option is set true, this no longer happens.
14449 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
14450 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
14451 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
14452 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
14453 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14454 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
14455 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
14458 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
14459 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
14460 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
14461 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
14462 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
14463 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
14464 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
14465 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
14466 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
14467 empty string, the option is ignored.
14470 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
14471 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
14472 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
14473 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
14474 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
14475 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
14476 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
14477 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
14478 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
14479 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
14480 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
14481 colons will become hyphens.
14484 .option message_logs main boolean true
14485 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
14486 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
14487 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
14488 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
14489 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
14490 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
14491 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
14492 which is not affected by this option.
14495 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
14496 .cindex "message" "size limit"
14497 .cindex "limit" "message size"
14498 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
14499 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
14500 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
14501 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
14502 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
14503 optionally followed by K or M.
14505 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
14506 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
14507 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
14508 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
14509 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14511 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
14512 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
14513 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
14514 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
14515 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
14516 message that an individual transport can process.
14518 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
14519 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
14520 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
14521 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
14522 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. Eg, with a
14523 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
14524 some problems may result.
14526 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
14527 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
14528 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
14531 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
14532 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
14533 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
14535 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
14537 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
14538 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
14539 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
14540 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
14541 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
14544 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
14545 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
14546 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
14547 contains a full description of this facility.
14551 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
14552 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
14553 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
14554 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
14555 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
14558 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
14559 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
14560 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
14561 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
14562 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
14565 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
14566 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
14567 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
14568 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
14569 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
14571 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
14572 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
14575 never_users = root:daemon:bin
14577 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
14578 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
14582 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2"
14583 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
14584 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
14585 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
14586 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
14588 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
14589 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
14590 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
14591 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
14592 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
14593 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
14594 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
14596 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
14597 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
14598 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
14599 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
14600 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
14602 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
14603 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
14604 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
14605 some now infamous attacks.
14609 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
14610 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
14611 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
14614 Possible options may include:
14618 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
14620 &`cipher_server_preference`&
14622 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
14626 &`legacy_server_connect`&
14628 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
14630 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
14632 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
14634 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
14636 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
14640 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
14656 &`single_ecdh_use`&
14658 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
14660 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
14662 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
14666 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
14670 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
14671 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
14672 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
14673 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14674 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
14677 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14678 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
14679 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
14680 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
14681 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
14682 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
14683 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
14684 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
14685 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
14686 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
14689 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
14690 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
14691 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
14692 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
14693 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
14694 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
14695 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
14698 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
14699 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14700 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14703 .option perl_startup main string unset
14704 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14705 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14708 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
14709 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
14710 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
14711 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
14712 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
14713 PostgreSQL support.
14716 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
14717 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
14718 .cindex "pid file, path for"
14719 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
14720 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
14723 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
14725 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
14727 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
14728 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
14729 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
14732 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14733 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
14734 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
14735 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
14736 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
14737 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
14738 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
14739 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
14740 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
14743 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
14744 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
14745 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
14746 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
14747 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
14748 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
14749 volume of mail. Use with care!
14752 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
14753 .cindex "name" "of local host"
14754 .cindex "host" "name of local"
14755 .cindex "local host" "name of"
14756 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14757 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
14758 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
14759 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
14760 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
14761 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
14763 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
14764 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
14765 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
14766 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
14767 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
14768 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
14771 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
14772 .cindex "printing characters"
14773 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14774 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
14775 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
14776 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
14777 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
14778 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
14781 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
14782 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
14783 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
14784 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
14785 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
14789 .option process_log_path main string unset
14790 .cindex "process log path"
14791 .cindex "log" "process log"
14792 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
14793 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
14794 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
14795 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
14796 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
14797 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
14798 different spool directories.
14801 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
14805 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
14806 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
14807 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
14810 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
14811 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
14812 .cindex "address" "qualification"
14813 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
14814 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
14815 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
14816 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
14817 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
14818 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14820 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
14821 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
14822 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
14823 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
14824 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
14825 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
14826 &%primary_hostname%& value.
14829 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
14830 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
14831 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
14835 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14836 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
14837 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14838 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
14839 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
14840 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
14841 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
14842 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
14845 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
14847 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
14848 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
14849 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
14852 .option queue_only main boolean false
14853 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14854 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
14855 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
14856 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
14857 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
14858 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
14860 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
14861 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
14862 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
14863 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
14866 .option queue_only_file main string unset
14867 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14868 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
14869 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
14870 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
14871 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
14872 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
14873 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
14874 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
14876 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
14878 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
14879 &_/some/file_& exists.
14882 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
14883 .cindex "load average"
14884 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14885 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
14886 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
14887 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
14888 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
14889 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
14890 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14893 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
14894 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
14895 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
14896 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14899 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
14900 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
14901 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
14902 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
14903 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
14904 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
14905 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
14906 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
14907 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
14908 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14909 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
14910 re-evaluated for each message.
14913 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
14914 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14915 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
14916 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
14917 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
14918 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
14921 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
14922 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
14923 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
14924 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
14925 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
14926 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
14927 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
14928 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
14929 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
14930 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
14931 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
14932 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
14933 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
14937 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
14938 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
14939 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
14940 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
14941 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
14942 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
14943 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
14944 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
14945 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
14947 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
14948 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
14949 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
14950 the daemon's command line.
14952 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14953 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14954 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
14955 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
14956 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
14957 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
14958 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
14959 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
14960 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
14961 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
14962 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
14963 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
14964 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
14968 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
14969 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
14970 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
14971 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
14972 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
14973 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
14974 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
14976 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
14977 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
14978 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
14979 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
14980 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
14981 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
14982 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
14983 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
14984 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
14985 header lines. The default setting is:
14988 received_header_text = Received: \
14989 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
14990 {${if def:sender_ident \
14991 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
14992 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
14993 by $primary_hostname \
14994 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
14995 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
14996 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
14997 ${if def:sender_address \
14998 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
14999 id $message_exim_id\
15000 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
15003 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
15004 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
15005 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
15006 header lines such as the following:
15008 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
15009 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
15010 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
15011 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
15012 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
15013 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
15014 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
15016 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
15017 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
15018 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
15019 message was accepted.
15022 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
15023 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
15024 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
15025 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
15026 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
15027 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
15028 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
15029 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
15032 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15033 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15034 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15035 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15036 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
15037 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
15038 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
15039 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
15040 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
15041 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
15042 option was not set.
15045 .option recipients_max main integer 0
15046 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
15047 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
15048 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
15049 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
15050 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
15051 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
15052 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
15055 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
15056 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
15057 RCPT commands in a single message.
15060 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
15061 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
15062 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
15063 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
15064 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
15065 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
15066 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
15069 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
15070 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
15071 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
15072 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
15073 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
15074 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
15075 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
15076 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
15077 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
15078 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
15079 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
15080 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
15081 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
15082 tagged with its process id.
15084 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
15085 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
15086 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
15087 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
15090 .cindex "number of deliveries"
15091 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
15092 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
15093 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
15094 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
15095 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
15096 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
15097 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
15098 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
15099 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
15100 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
15102 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
15103 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
15104 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
15105 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
15108 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15109 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
15110 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
15111 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
15112 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
15114 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
15116 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
15117 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
15120 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
15121 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
15122 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
15123 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
15124 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
15128 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
15129 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
15130 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
15131 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
15132 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
15133 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
15134 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
15138 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
15139 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
15140 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
15141 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
15142 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
15143 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
15144 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
15145 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
15146 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
15147 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
15150 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
15151 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15154 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15156 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
15157 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches an item
15160 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 5s
15161 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
15162 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
15163 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
15164 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
15167 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15168 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15169 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15170 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15171 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
15172 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
15173 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
15174 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
15175 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
15176 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
15179 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
15180 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
15181 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
15182 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
15183 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
15184 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
15185 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
15186 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
15187 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
15188 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
15189 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
15193 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
15194 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
15195 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15197 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
15198 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
15199 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
15200 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
15201 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
15202 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15204 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
15205 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
15206 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
15207 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
15210 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
15211 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
15212 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
15213 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
15214 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
15215 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
15216 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
15217 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
15219 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
15220 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
15221 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
15222 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
15223 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
15224 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
15225 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
15226 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
15229 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15230 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
15231 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
15232 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
15236 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15237 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15239 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
15240 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15241 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
15242 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
15243 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
15244 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
15245 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
15246 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
15247 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
15251 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
15252 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
15253 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
15254 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
15255 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
15256 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
15257 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
15258 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
15259 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
15260 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
15261 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
15263 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
15264 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
15265 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
15266 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
15267 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
15268 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
15272 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
15273 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15274 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15275 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
15276 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
15277 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
15278 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
15279 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
15280 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
15281 to all messages received in the same connection.
15283 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
15284 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
15285 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
15286 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
15289 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15290 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15292 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 10 &&&
15293 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
15294 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15295 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
15296 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
15297 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
15298 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
15299 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
15300 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
15301 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
15302 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
15303 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
15304 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
15307 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
15308 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
15309 .cindex "host" "reserved"
15310 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
15311 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
15312 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
15313 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
15314 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
15315 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
15316 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
15317 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
15320 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
15321 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
15322 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
15323 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
15326 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
15327 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
15328 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
15329 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15330 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
15331 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
15332 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
15333 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
15334 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
15336 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
15337 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
15338 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
15339 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
15341 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
15342 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
15343 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
15344 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
15345 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
15348 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
15349 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
15352 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
15353 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
15354 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
15355 &%helo_data%& value.
15357 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
15358 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
15359 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
15360 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
15361 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
15362 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
15363 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
15365 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
15366 $version_number $tod_full
15368 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
15369 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
15370 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
15371 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
15372 multiline response).
15375 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
15376 .cindex "checking disk space"
15377 .cindex "disk space, checking"
15378 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15379 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
15380 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
15381 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
15382 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
15383 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
15386 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
15387 .cindex "connection backlog"
15388 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
15389 .cindex "backlog of connections"
15390 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
15391 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
15392 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
15393 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
15394 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
15395 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
15396 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
15397 attacks by SYN flooding.
15400 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
15401 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
15402 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
15403 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
15404 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
15405 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
15406 fewer, but they still exist.
15408 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
15409 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
15410 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
15411 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
15412 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
15413 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
15414 does detect many instances.
15416 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
15417 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
15418 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
15419 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
15423 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
15424 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
15425 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15426 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
15427 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
15428 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
15429 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
15430 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
15433 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
15434 $sender_host_address
15436 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
15437 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
15438 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
15439 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
15440 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
15444 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
15445 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
15446 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
15447 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
15448 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
15451 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
15452 .cindex "load average"
15453 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
15454 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
15455 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
15456 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
15457 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
15458 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
15462 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
15463 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
15464 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
15465 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
15466 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
15468 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
15470 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
15471 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
15472 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
15473 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
15474 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
15476 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
15477 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
15478 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
15479 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
15480 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
15481 not count towards the limit.
15485 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
15486 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
15487 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
15488 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
15489 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
15492 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
15493 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
15497 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15498 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
15499 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
15500 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
15501 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
15502 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
15505 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
15506 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
15507 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
15508 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
15510 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
15511 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
15512 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
15513 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
15517 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
15519 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
15520 fractional parts are allowed here.
15522 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
15524 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
15525 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
15528 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
15529 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
15531 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
15532 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
15534 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
15535 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
15536 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
15537 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
15540 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
15541 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15544 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
15545 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15548 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time 5m
15549 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
15550 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
15551 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
15552 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
15553 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
15554 the message is abandoned.
15555 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
15557 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
15558 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
15560 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
15561 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
15565 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
15566 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
15567 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
15568 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
15569 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
15572 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15573 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
15574 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
15577 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
15578 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
15579 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
15580 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
15581 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
15582 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
15583 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
15584 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
15585 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
15586 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
15588 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
15589 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
15592 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
15593 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
15594 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
15595 The default value is
15599 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
15603 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
15604 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
15605 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
15606 .cindex "directories, multiple"
15607 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
15608 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
15609 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
15610 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
15611 arrival of the message.
15613 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
15614 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
15615 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
15616 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
15617 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
15619 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
15620 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
15621 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
15622 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
15623 automatically deleted.
15625 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
15626 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
15627 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
15628 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
15629 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
15630 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
15631 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
15632 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
15633 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
15636 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
15637 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
15638 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
15639 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
15640 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
15641 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
15642 &$primary_hostname$&.
15644 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
15645 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
15646 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
15647 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
15648 as failures in the configuration file.
15650 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
15651 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
15653 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
15654 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
15655 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
15656 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
15658 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
15659 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
15660 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
15661 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
15662 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
15663 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
15665 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
15666 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
15667 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
15668 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
15669 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
15670 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
15671 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
15674 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
15675 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
15676 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
15677 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
15678 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
15679 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
15680 domain causes a syntax error.
15681 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
15685 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
15686 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
15687 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
15688 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
15689 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
15690 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
15691 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
15692 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
15693 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
15694 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
15695 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
15696 the LOG_ALERT priority.
15699 .option syslog_facility main string unset
15700 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
15701 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15702 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
15703 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
15704 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15705 details of Exim's logging.
15709 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
15710 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
15711 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15712 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
15713 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
15717 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
15718 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
15719 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
15720 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15721 details of Exim's logging.
15724 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
15725 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
15726 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
15727 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
15728 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
15729 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
15730 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
15731 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
15732 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
15733 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
15734 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
15737 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
15738 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
15739 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
15740 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
15741 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
15742 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15745 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
15746 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
15747 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
15748 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
15749 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15751 .option system_filter_group main string unset
15752 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
15753 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
15754 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
15755 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
15757 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
15758 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
15759 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
15760 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
15761 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
15762 contains the pipe command.
15765 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
15766 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
15767 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
15768 is used in a system filter.
15771 .option system_filter_user main string unset
15772 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
15773 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
15774 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
15775 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
15776 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
15777 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
15778 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
15779 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
15780 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
15782 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
15783 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
15784 transport option overrides.
15787 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
15788 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
15789 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
15790 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
15791 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
15792 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
15793 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
15794 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
15795 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
15796 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
15797 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
15798 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
15802 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
15803 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
15804 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
15805 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
15806 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
15807 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
15808 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
15809 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
15810 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
15811 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
15813 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
15814 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
15815 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
15818 .option timezone main string unset
15819 .cindex "timezone, setting"
15820 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
15821 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
15822 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
15823 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
15827 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
15828 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
15829 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
15830 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
15831 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
15832 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
15835 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15836 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
15837 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
15838 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
15839 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
15840 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
15841 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
15842 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
15845 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
15846 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
15847 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
15848 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15849 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
15850 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
15851 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15853 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
15854 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
15855 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
15856 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
15858 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
15859 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
15860 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
15861 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
15863 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
15864 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
15865 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
15866 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
15867 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
15869 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
15872 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
15873 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
15874 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
15875 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
15876 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
15877 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
15879 The value must be at least 1024.
15881 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
15882 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
15883 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
15885 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
15888 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
15889 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
15890 larger prime than requested.
15893 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
15894 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
15895 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
15896 to be used by Exim.
15898 If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
15899 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
15900 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
15901 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
15902 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
15903 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
15904 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
15906 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
15909 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
15910 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
15911 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
15912 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
15914 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
15915 a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
15916 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
15917 in IKE is assigned number 23.
15919 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
15920 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
15921 "ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
15924 The available primes are:
15925 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
15926 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
15927 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
15929 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
15930 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
15933 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
15934 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
15935 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
15936 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
15937 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
15941 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
15942 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
15943 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15944 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
15945 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
15946 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
15947 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15949 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
15952 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
15953 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
15954 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
15955 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
15956 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
15957 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
15961 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
15962 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
15963 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
15964 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
15965 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
15966 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
15967 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
15968 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
15969 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
15970 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
15971 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
15974 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15975 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15976 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15977 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
15980 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! unset
15981 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15982 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15983 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15984 a file containing permitted certificates for clients that
15985 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. Alternatively, if you
15986 are using OpenSSL, you can set &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a
15987 directory containing certificate files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the
15988 option must be set to the name of a single file if you are using GnuTLS.
15990 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
15991 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
15992 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
15993 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
15994 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
15995 use OpenSSL with a directory.
15997 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16000 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16001 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16002 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16003 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
16004 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
16005 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
16006 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
16007 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
16009 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
16010 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
16011 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
16012 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
16013 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
16014 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
16015 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
16017 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
16018 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
16019 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
16020 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
16021 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
16022 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
16023 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
16026 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
16030 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
16031 .cindex "trusted groups"
16032 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
16033 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16034 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
16035 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
16036 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
16037 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
16038 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
16041 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
16042 .cindex "trusted users"
16043 .cindex "user" "trusted"
16044 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16045 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
16046 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
16047 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
16048 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
16049 Exim user are trusted.
16051 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
16052 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
16053 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
16054 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
16055 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
16056 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
16057 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
16058 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
16059 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
16062 .option unknown_username main string unset
16063 See &%unknown_login%&.
16065 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
16066 .cindex "trusted users"
16067 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
16068 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
16069 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
16070 .cindex "envelope sender"
16071 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
16072 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
16073 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
16074 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
16075 is used) is ignored.
16077 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
16078 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
16080 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
16082 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
16083 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
16084 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
16085 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
16086 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
16087 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
16088 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
16089 followed by a hyphen
16090 by a setting like this:
16092 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
16094 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
16095 restriction, you can use
16097 untrusted_set_sender = *
16099 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
16100 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
16101 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
16102 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
16103 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
16104 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
16105 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
16106 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
16108 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
16109 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
16110 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
16111 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
16115 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
16116 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16117 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16118 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
16119 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
16120 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
16121 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
16122 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
16123 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
16124 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
16126 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
16127 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
16129 The pattern can be seen by running
16131 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
16133 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
16134 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
16135 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
16136 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
16137 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
16138 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
16141 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
16142 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
16145 .option warn_message_file main string unset
16146 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
16147 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
16148 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
16149 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
16150 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
16151 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
16152 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
16155 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
16156 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
16157 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
16158 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
16159 .ecindex IIDconfima
16160 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
16165 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16166 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16168 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
16169 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
16170 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
16171 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
16172 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
16174 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
16175 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
16176 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
16177 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
16178 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
16182 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
16183 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
16184 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
16185 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
16186 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
16187 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
16188 delivery of the address to be deferred.
16190 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16191 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
16192 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
16193 routers, and the eventual transport.
16195 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
16196 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
16197 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
16198 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
16199 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
16201 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
16202 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
16203 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
16204 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
16205 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
16207 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
16208 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
16209 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
16211 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
16213 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
16215 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
16217 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
16218 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
16220 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
16221 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16222 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
16223 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
16224 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
16225 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
16226 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
16230 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
16232 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
16233 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
16234 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
16235 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
16236 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
16241 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
16242 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
16243 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
16244 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
16245 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
16246 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
16247 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
16248 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
16249 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
16250 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
16253 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
16255 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
16258 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
16260 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
16261 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
16262 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
16263 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
16266 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
16267 .cindex "case of local parts"
16268 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
16269 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
16270 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
16271 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
16272 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
16273 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
16274 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
16277 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16278 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
16279 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
16280 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
16281 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
16282 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
16283 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
16284 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
16285 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
16287 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
16288 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
16289 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
16290 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
16294 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
16295 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
16296 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
16297 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
16299 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
16300 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
16301 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
16302 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
16303 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
16304 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
16305 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
16306 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
16307 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
16308 the router is skipped.
16310 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
16311 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
16312 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
16313 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
16314 setting to achieve this. For example:
16316 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
16318 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
16319 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
16320 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
16324 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
16325 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
16326 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
16327 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
16328 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
16329 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
16330 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
16331 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
16333 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
16334 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
16336 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
16337 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
16339 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
16340 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
16341 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
16343 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16345 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
16347 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
16350 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
16352 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16353 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
16357 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
16358 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
16359 be specified using &%condition%&.
16362 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
16363 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
16364 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
16365 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
16366 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
16367 output, and Exim carries on processing.
16368 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
16369 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
16370 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
16371 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
16372 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
16373 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
16377 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
16378 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
16379 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
16380 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
16381 transport option of the same name.
16384 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
16385 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
16386 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
16387 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
16388 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
16389 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
16390 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
16391 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
16395 .option driver routers string unset
16396 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
16401 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
16402 .cindex "envelope sender"
16403 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
16404 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
16405 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
16406 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
16407 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
16408 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
16409 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
16411 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
16412 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
16413 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
16416 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
16417 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
16418 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
16419 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
16421 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
16422 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
16423 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
16424 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
16430 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
16431 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
16432 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
16433 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
16434 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
16436 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16437 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
16438 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
16439 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
16440 setting &%return_path%&.
16442 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
16443 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
16444 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
16448 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
16449 .cindex "address" "testing"
16450 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
16451 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
16452 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
16453 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
16454 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
16455 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
16456 on for the system alias file.
16457 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16460 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
16461 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
16462 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
16466 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
16467 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
16468 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
16469 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
16473 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
16474 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16475 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
16479 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
16480 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16481 verifying a sender, verification fails.
16485 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
16486 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
16487 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
16488 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
16489 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
16490 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
16491 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
16492 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
16493 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
16495 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
16496 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
16497 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
16498 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
16499 transport for further details.
16502 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
16503 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
16504 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16505 .cindex "transport" "local"
16506 .cindex "router" "setting group"
16507 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
16508 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
16510 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
16511 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
16512 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
16513 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
16514 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16518 .option headers_add routers string&!! unset
16519 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
16520 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
16521 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
16522 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
16523 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
16524 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
16525 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
16526 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
16527 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
16528 &"see"& the added header lines.
16530 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
16531 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If the expanded string is empty, or if
16532 the expansion is forced to fail, the option has no effect. Other expansion
16533 failures are treated as configuration errors.
16535 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
16536 for a router; all listed headers are added.
16538 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
16539 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
16541 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
16542 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
16543 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
16544 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
16545 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
16546 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
16547 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
16548 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
16549 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
16550 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
16554 .option headers_remove routers string&!! unset
16555 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
16556 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
16557 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
16558 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
16559 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
16560 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
16561 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
16562 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
16563 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
16564 &"see"& the original header lines.
16566 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
16567 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If the expansion is forced to fail,
16568 the option has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
16571 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
16572 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
16574 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
16575 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
16577 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
16578 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
16579 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
16580 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
16583 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
16584 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
16585 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
16586 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
16587 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
16588 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
16589 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
16592 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
16596 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
16598 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
16599 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
16600 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
16601 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
16602 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
16603 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
16605 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
16606 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
16608 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
16609 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
16611 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
16612 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
16614 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
16615 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
16616 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
16617 domain that is being routed.
16619 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
16620 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
16623 .option initgroups routers boolean false
16624 .cindex "additional groups"
16625 .cindex "groups" "additional"
16626 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16627 .cindex "transport" "local"
16628 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
16629 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
16630 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
16631 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
16632 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16636 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
16637 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
16638 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
16639 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
16640 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
16641 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
16644 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
16645 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
16646 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
16647 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
16648 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
16649 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
16650 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
16651 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
16652 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
16654 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16655 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
16656 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
16657 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
16658 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
16659 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
16660 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
16661 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
16662 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
16663 the relevant transport.
16665 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
16666 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
16667 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
16670 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
16671 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
16672 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
16673 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
16674 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
16678 local_part_prefix = real-
16680 transport = local_delivery
16682 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
16683 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
16685 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
16686 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
16689 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
16690 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
16691 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
16692 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
16695 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
16696 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
16700 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
16701 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
16702 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
16703 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
16704 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
16705 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
16706 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
16707 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
16708 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
16712 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
16713 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
16717 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
16718 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
16719 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
16720 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
16721 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16723 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
16724 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
16727 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
16729 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
16730 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
16731 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
16732 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
16733 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
16734 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
16735 each virtual domain:
16739 local_parts = postmaster
16740 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
16744 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
16745 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
16746 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
16747 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
16748 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
16749 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
16750 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
16751 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
16752 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
16753 redirect addresses.
16757 .option more routers boolean&!! true
16758 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16759 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16760 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16761 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
16762 delivery to be deferred.
16764 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
16765 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
16767 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
16768 means of the setting
16772 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
16773 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
16774 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
16776 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
16777 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
16778 controls what happens next.
16781 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
16782 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
16783 .cindex "router" "timeout"
16784 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
16785 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
16786 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
16787 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
16788 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
16790 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
16791 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
16792 applies to all of them.
16796 .option pass_router routers string unset
16797 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
16798 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
16799 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
16800 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
16801 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
16802 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
16803 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
16804 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
16805 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
16806 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
16810 .option redirect_router routers string unset
16811 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
16812 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
16813 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
16814 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
16815 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
16817 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
16818 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
16819 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
16820 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
16824 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
16825 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
16826 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
16827 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
16828 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
16829 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
16830 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
16832 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
16833 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
16834 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
16835 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
16837 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
16838 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
16839 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
16840 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
16841 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
16844 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
16845 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
16848 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
16849 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
16850 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
16851 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
16852 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
16853 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
16854 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
16855 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
16857 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
16858 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
16859 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
16860 operates as follows:
16862 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
16863 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
16864 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
16865 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
16868 require_files = mail:/some/file
16869 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
16871 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
16872 &%require_files%& condition fails.
16874 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
16875 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
16876 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
16877 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
16879 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
16880 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
16881 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
16882 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
16883 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
16885 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
16886 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
16887 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
16888 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
16889 check again in that process.
16891 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
16892 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
16893 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
16894 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
16895 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
16896 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
16897 as if the file did not exist. For example:
16899 require_files = +/some/file
16901 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
16902 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
16903 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
16907 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
16908 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
16909 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
16910 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
16911 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
16912 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
16913 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
16914 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
16917 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
16918 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
16919 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
16920 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
16921 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
16924 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
16925 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
16926 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
16930 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
16931 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
16932 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
16934 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
16935 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
16936 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
16937 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
16938 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
16939 cause the router to defer.
16941 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
16942 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
16944 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16946 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
16947 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
16949 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
16950 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
16951 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
16952 of these values that is set:
16955 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
16957 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
16959 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
16961 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
16964 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
16965 router, but not for the transport.
16969 .option self routers string freeze
16970 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
16971 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
16972 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
16973 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
16974 and &(manualroute)& routers.
16975 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
16977 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
16978 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
16979 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
16980 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
16981 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
16983 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
16984 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
16985 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
16986 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
16987 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
16992 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
16994 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
16995 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
16996 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
16997 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
16999 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
17000 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
17001 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
17006 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
17007 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
17008 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
17009 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
17010 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
17011 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
17017 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
17018 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
17019 be passed to the next router.
17022 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
17025 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
17026 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
17027 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
17028 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
17029 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
17030 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
17035 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
17036 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
17037 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
17038 address matches something on the list.
17039 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17042 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
17043 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
17044 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
17045 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
17046 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
17047 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
17048 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
17052 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
17053 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
17054 .cindex "packet radio"
17055 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
17056 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
17057 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
17058 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
17059 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
17060 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
17061 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
17062 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
17064 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17065 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
17066 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
17067 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
17068 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
17069 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
17070 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
17071 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
17072 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
17073 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
17075 translate_ip_address = \
17076 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
17079 The file would contain lines like
17081 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
17082 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
17084 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
17089 .option transport routers string&!! unset
17090 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
17091 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
17092 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
17093 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
17094 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
17095 delivery is deferred.
17097 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
17098 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
17099 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
17103 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
17104 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
17105 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
17106 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
17107 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
17108 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
17109 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
17110 overridden by a setting on the transport.
17111 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17112 logged, and delivery is deferred.
17113 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
17119 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
17120 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
17121 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
17122 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
17123 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
17124 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
17125 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
17126 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
17127 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17128 logged, and delivery is deferred.
17130 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
17131 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
17132 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
17133 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
17134 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
17136 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
17142 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
17143 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
17144 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17145 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17146 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17147 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
17148 delivery to be deferred.
17150 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
17151 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
17152 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
17153 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
17154 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
17155 sometimes true and sometimes false).
17157 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
17158 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
17159 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
17160 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
17161 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
17162 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
17163 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
17164 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
17166 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
17167 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
17168 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
17169 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
17170 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
17171 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
17172 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
17173 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
17174 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
17175 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17177 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
17178 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
17179 subsequent routers.
17182 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
17183 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
17184 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17185 .cindex "transport" "local"
17186 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
17187 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
17188 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17189 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
17190 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17191 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17192 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
17193 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
17194 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
17195 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
17196 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
17197 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17201 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
17202 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
17203 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17206 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
17207 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
17209 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
17210 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address or
17211 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
17212 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
17213 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
17214 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
17216 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
17217 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
17218 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
17222 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
17223 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
17225 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
17226 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17230 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
17231 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
17232 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
17233 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17235 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
17236 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
17243 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17244 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17246 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
17247 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
17248 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
17249 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
17250 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
17251 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
17252 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
17253 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
17254 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
17258 domains = mydomain.example
17260 transport = local_delivery
17262 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
17263 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
17264 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
17265 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
17272 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17273 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17275 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
17276 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
17277 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
17278 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
17279 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
17280 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
17282 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
17283 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
17284 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
17285 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
17288 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
17289 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
17290 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
17291 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
17292 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17293 generic option, the router declines.
17295 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
17296 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
17297 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
17299 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17300 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17301 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
17302 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
17303 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
17304 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
17307 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
17308 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
17309 Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
17310 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
17311 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
17312 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
17314 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
17315 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
17316 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
17317 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
17318 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
17319 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
17320 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
17321 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
17322 case routing fails.
17325 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
17326 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
17327 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
17328 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
17329 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
17331 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
17333 The domain does not exist in DNS
17335 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
17336 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
17337 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
17339 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
17341 MX record points to a non-existent host.
17343 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
17344 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
17346 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
17347 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
17349 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
17350 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
17352 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
17353 not be found in the MX records (see below)
17359 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
17360 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
17361 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
17363 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
17364 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
17365 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
17366 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
17367 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
17368 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
17369 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17372 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
17373 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
17374 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
17375 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
17376 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
17377 required. For example,
17381 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
17382 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
17383 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
17384 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
17385 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
17388 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
17389 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
17390 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
17391 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
17392 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
17393 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
17395 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
17396 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
17397 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
17398 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
17399 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
17400 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
17401 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
17402 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
17404 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
17405 when there is a DNS lookup error.
17409 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17410 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
17411 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
17412 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
17413 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
17414 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
17415 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
17418 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
17420 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
17421 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
17422 the address record.
17425 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17426 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
17427 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
17428 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
17433 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
17434 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
17435 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
17436 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
17437 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
17438 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
17439 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
17440 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
17441 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
17446 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
17447 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
17448 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
17449 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
17450 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
17451 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
17452 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
17453 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
17454 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
17455 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
17456 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
17458 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
17459 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
17462 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
17463 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
17464 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
17465 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
17466 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
17470 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
17471 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
17472 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
17473 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
17474 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17475 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17476 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17477 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17479 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17480 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
17481 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17482 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
17483 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
17484 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
17485 without processing them independently,
17486 provided the following conditions are met:
17489 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
17490 &%headers_remove%&.
17492 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
17499 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
17500 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
17501 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
17502 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
17503 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
17504 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
17505 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
17506 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
17507 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
17508 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
17510 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
17511 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
17516 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17517 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
17518 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
17519 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
17524 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
17525 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
17526 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
17527 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
17530 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
17532 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
17533 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
17534 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
17535 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
17536 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
17537 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
17540 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
17541 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
17542 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
17543 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
17544 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
17546 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
17547 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
17548 such as that implied by
17552 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
17553 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
17554 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
17555 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
17565 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17566 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17568 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
17569 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
17570 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
17571 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
17572 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
17573 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
17574 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
17575 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
17576 router handles the address
17580 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
17581 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
17582 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
17584 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
17586 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
17587 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
17589 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
17590 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
17591 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
17592 &%self%& option determines what happens.
17594 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
17595 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
17596 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
17597 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
17601 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17602 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17604 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
17605 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
17606 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
17607 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
17608 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
17609 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
17612 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
17614 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
17616 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
17617 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
17618 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
17619 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
17620 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
17621 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
17622 must not be specified for it.
17624 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
17625 .option hosts iplookup string unset
17626 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
17627 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
17628 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
17629 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
17630 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
17633 .option optional iplookup boolean false
17634 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
17635 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
17636 delivery to the address is deferred.
17639 .option port iplookup integer 0
17640 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
17641 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
17645 .option protocol iplookup string udp
17646 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
17647 protocols is to be used.
17650 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
17651 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
17654 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
17656 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
17657 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
17660 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
17661 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
17662 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
17663 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
17664 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
17665 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
17666 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
17667 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
17670 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
17671 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
17672 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
17673 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
17674 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
17675 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
17676 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
17677 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
17678 following could be used:
17680 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
17681 reroute = $local_part@$1
17684 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
17685 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
17686 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
17687 call. It does not apply to UDP.
17692 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17693 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17695 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
17696 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
17697 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
17698 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
17699 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
17700 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
17701 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
17702 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
17703 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
17704 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
17706 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
17707 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
17708 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
17709 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
17710 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
17711 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
17712 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
17715 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
17716 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
17717 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
17718 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
17719 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
17720 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
17721 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
17724 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
17725 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
17726 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
17727 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
17728 below, following the list of private options.
17731 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
17733 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
17734 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
17736 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
17737 See &%host_find_failed%&.
17739 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
17740 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
17741 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
17742 of the following values:
17751 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
17752 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
17753 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
17756 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
17757 router only if &%more%& is true.
17759 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
17760 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
17761 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
17762 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
17764 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
17765 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
17766 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
17769 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
17770 .cindex "randomized host list"
17771 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
17772 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
17773 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
17774 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
17775 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
17776 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
17777 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
17778 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
17780 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
17781 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
17782 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
17783 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
17785 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
17787 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
17788 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
17789 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
17790 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
17791 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
17794 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
17795 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
17796 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
17799 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
17801 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
17802 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
17806 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
17807 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
17808 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
17809 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
17812 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
17813 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
17814 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
17815 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
17816 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17817 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17818 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17819 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17821 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17822 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
17823 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17824 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
17825 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
17826 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
17827 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
17828 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
17833 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
17834 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
17835 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
17836 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
17837 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17838 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
17840 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
17842 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
17846 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
17847 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17849 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
17850 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
17851 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
17852 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
17853 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
17854 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
17855 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
17856 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
17857 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
17858 in a &%route_list%&).
17860 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
17861 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
17862 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
17863 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
17867 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
17868 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
17869 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
17870 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
17871 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
17872 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
17873 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
17876 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
17877 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17879 This data can be accessed by setting
17881 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
17883 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
17884 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
17885 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
17886 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
17887 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
17892 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
17893 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
17894 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
17895 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
17896 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
17897 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
17898 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17900 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
17901 variables are set during its expansion:
17904 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17905 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
17906 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
17908 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
17911 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
17913 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
17916 .vindex "&$value$&"
17917 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
17918 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
17920 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
17924 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
17925 semicolon is the default route list separator.
17929 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
17930 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
17931 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
17932 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
17933 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
17934 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
17937 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
17938 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
17939 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
17941 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
17942 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
17945 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
17946 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
17947 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
17948 number follows. For example:
17950 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
17954 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
17955 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
17956 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
17957 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
17958 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
17961 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
17962 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
17963 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
17964 records in the DNS. For example:
17966 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
17968 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
17971 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
17973 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
17974 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
17975 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
17976 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
17977 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
17978 happens is controlled by the
17979 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17980 &%self%& option of the router.
17982 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
17983 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
17984 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
17985 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
17986 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
17987 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
17988 defined by MX preferences.
17990 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
17991 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
17992 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
17994 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
17995 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
17996 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
17997 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
17999 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
18000 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
18003 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
18004 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
18005 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
18007 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
18008 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
18012 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
18013 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
18014 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
18015 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
18016 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
18017 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
18018 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
18021 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
18022 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18024 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
18025 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18027 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
18028 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
18029 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
18031 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
18032 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
18033 timeout), delivery is deferred.
18038 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
18039 domain2 host4:host5
18041 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
18042 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
18043 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
18044 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
18047 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
18048 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
18049 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
18050 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
18055 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
18056 &%host_find_failed%& option.
18059 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
18060 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
18064 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
18065 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
18066 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
18069 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
18070 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
18071 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
18072 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
18074 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
18076 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
18077 your first router something like this:
18080 driver = manualroute
18081 domains = !+local_domains
18082 transport = remote_smtp
18083 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
18085 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
18086 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
18087 they are tried in order
18088 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
18089 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
18092 driver = manualroute
18093 transport = remote_smtp
18094 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
18096 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
18097 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
18098 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
18099 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
18100 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
18101 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
18102 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
18103 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
18106 .cindex "mail hub example"
18107 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
18108 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
18109 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
18110 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
18111 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
18112 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
18113 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
18114 lookup is easier to manage.
18116 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
18117 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
18121 driver = manualroute
18122 transport = remote_smtp
18123 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
18125 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
18126 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
18127 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
18128 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
18129 domain can be used to find the host:
18132 driver = manualroute
18133 transport = remote_smtp
18134 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
18136 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
18137 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
18138 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
18142 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
18143 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
18144 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
18145 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
18146 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
18147 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
18150 driver = manualroute
18151 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
18152 route_list = saved.domain.example
18154 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
18155 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
18156 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
18159 driver = manualroute
18161 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
18162 *.saved.domain2.example \
18163 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
18166 .vindex "&$domain$&"
18168 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
18169 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
18170 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
18171 the address if the lookup fails.
18174 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
18175 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
18176 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
18177 one way it can be done:
18183 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
18184 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
18185 return_fail_output = true
18190 driver = manualroute
18192 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
18194 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
18196 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
18198 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
18199 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
18200 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
18202 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
18203 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
18212 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18213 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18215 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
18216 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
18217 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
18218 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
18219 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
18220 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
18221 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
18222 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
18223 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
18224 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
18226 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
18228 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
18229 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
18230 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
18231 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
18232 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
18235 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
18236 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
18237 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
18238 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
18239 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
18240 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
18243 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
18244 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
18245 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
18246 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
18247 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
18248 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
18249 not set, a value for the gid also.
18251 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
18252 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
18253 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
18254 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
18255 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
18256 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
18260 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
18261 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
18262 before running the command.
18265 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
18266 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
18267 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
18271 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
18272 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
18273 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
18274 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
18275 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
18278 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
18281 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
18282 &%no_more%& is set.
18284 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
18285 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
18286 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
18287 included in the SMTP response.
18289 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
18290 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
18291 included in any SMTP response.
18293 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
18295 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
18296 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
18298 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
18299 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
18300 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
18303 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
18304 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
18307 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
18308 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
18310 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
18311 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
18312 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
18313 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
18315 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
18316 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
18317 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
18318 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
18319 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
18321 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
18322 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
18323 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
18324 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
18325 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
18327 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18328 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
18329 variable. For example, this return line
18331 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
18333 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
18334 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
18335 .ecindex IIDquerou1
18336 .ecindex IIDquerou2
18341 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18342 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18344 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
18345 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
18346 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
18347 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
18348 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
18349 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
18350 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
18351 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
18352 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
18353 redirected in several different ways:
18356 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
18359 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
18361 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
18363 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
18365 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
18367 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
18369 It can be discarded.
18372 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
18373 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
18374 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
18375 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
18379 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
18380 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
18381 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
18382 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
18383 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
18384 aliases, in a configuration like this:
18388 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
18390 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
18391 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
18392 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
18393 cause delivery to be deferred.
18395 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
18396 &_.forward_& files, like this:
18401 file = $home/.forward
18404 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
18405 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
18406 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
18407 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
18412 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
18413 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
18414 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
18415 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
18418 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
18419 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
18420 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
18421 practice the router may not be able to operate.
18423 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
18424 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
18425 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
18426 saves some resources.
18434 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
18435 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
18436 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
18437 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
18438 can be interpreted in two different ways:
18441 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
18442 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
18443 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
18444 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
18445 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
18446 document is intended for use by end users.
18448 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
18449 described in the next section.
18452 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
18453 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
18454 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
18455 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
18456 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
18460 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
18461 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
18462 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
18463 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
18464 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
18465 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
18466 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
18467 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
18468 commas or newlines.
18469 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
18472 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
18473 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
18474 next newline character is ignored.
18476 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
18477 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
18478 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
18479 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
18482 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18483 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
18484 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
18485 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
18486 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
18487 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
18490 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
18494 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
18495 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
18496 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
18497 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
18498 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
18499 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
18500 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
18501 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
18502 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
18503 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
18504 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
18506 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
18507 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
18508 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
18509 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
18510 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
18512 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
18514 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
18515 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
18516 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
18517 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
18518 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
18521 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
18522 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
18523 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
18524 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
18525 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
18527 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
18528 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
18533 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
18534 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
18537 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
18539 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
18540 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
18541 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
18542 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
18543 should really contain
18545 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
18547 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
18548 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
18549 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
18553 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
18554 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
18555 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
18558 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
18559 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
18560 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
18561 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
18562 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
18563 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
18564 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
18566 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
18567 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
18568 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
18569 in double quotes, for example:
18571 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
18573 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
18574 quote just the command. An item such as
18576 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
18578 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
18581 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
18582 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
18583 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
18584 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
18585 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
18586 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
18587 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
18588 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
18589 an &%accept%& router.
18593 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
18594 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
18595 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
18596 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
18598 /home/world/minbari
18600 is treated as a file name, but
18602 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
18604 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
18605 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
18606 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
18607 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
18609 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
18610 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
18612 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
18613 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
18614 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
18615 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
18618 .cindex "included address list"
18619 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
18620 If an item is of the form
18622 :include:<path name>
18624 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
18625 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
18626 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
18627 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
18628 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
18629 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
18631 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
18633 It must be given as
18635 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
18638 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
18639 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
18640 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
18641 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
18642 .cindex "black hole"
18643 .cindex "abandoning mail"
18644 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
18645 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
18646 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
18648 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
18649 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
18650 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
18651 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
18655 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
18656 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
18657 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
18658 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
18659 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
18660 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
18661 redirection items of the form
18666 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
18667 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
18668 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
18669 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
18671 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
18673 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
18675 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
18676 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
18678 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
18679 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
18680 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
18682 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18683 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
18684 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
18685 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
18686 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
18687 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
18688 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
18689 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
18690 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
18693 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
18694 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
18695 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
18696 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
18698 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
18699 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
18700 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
18701 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
18702 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
18704 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
18705 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
18706 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
18707 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
18708 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
18712 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
18713 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
18714 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
18715 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
18716 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
18717 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
18718 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
18722 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
18723 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18724 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
18725 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
18726 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
18727 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
18728 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
18729 aliasing scheme of the type
18731 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
18735 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
18736 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
18737 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
18740 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
18741 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
18743 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
18744 the pipes are distinct.
18748 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
18749 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
18750 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
18751 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
18752 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
18753 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
18754 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
18755 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
18756 can be used to avoid this.
18759 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
18760 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
18761 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
18762 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
18763 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
18764 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
18765 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
18769 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
18771 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
18772 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
18775 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
18776 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
18777 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
18780 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
18781 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
18782 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
18783 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
18786 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
18787 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
18788 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
18789 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
18790 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
18791 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
18792 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
18794 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
18795 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
18798 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
18799 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
18800 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
18801 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
18802 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
18806 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
18807 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
18808 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
18809 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
18810 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
18811 let ordinary users do.
18815 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
18816 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
18817 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
18818 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
18819 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
18820 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
18822 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
18823 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
18824 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
18825 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
18826 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
18827 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
18829 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
18831 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
18832 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
18833 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
18834 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
18835 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
18836 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
18837 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
18838 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
18841 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
18842 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
18843 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
18844 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
18845 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
18846 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
18847 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
18848 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
18852 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
18853 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
18854 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
18855 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
18856 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
18857 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
18860 .option data redirect string&!! unset
18861 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
18862 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
18863 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
18864 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
18865 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
18867 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
18868 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
18869 terminated with newline characters. For example:
18871 data = #Exim filter\n\
18872 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
18874 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
18875 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
18876 choice into a newline.
18879 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
18880 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
18881 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18882 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18883 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
18886 .option file redirect string&!! unset
18887 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
18888 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
18889 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
18890 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
18891 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
18892 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
18893 entirely of comments), the router declines.
18895 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
18896 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
18897 runs a check on the containing directory,
18898 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
18899 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
18900 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
18901 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
18902 not, the router declines.
18905 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
18906 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
18907 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
18908 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18909 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18910 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
18911 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
18914 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
18915 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
18916 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
18917 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
18918 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
18921 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
18922 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
18926 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
18927 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
18928 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18933 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
18934 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
18935 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
18936 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
18937 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
18938 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
18939 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
18940 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
18941 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
18944 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
18945 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
18946 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18947 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
18950 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
18951 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
18952 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18953 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
18955 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
18956 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
18957 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
18958 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
18959 &_.forward_& files).
18962 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
18963 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18964 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
18967 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
18968 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
18969 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
18970 of the embedded Perl support.
18973 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
18974 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18975 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
18978 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
18979 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18980 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
18983 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
18984 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
18985 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
18986 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
18987 &%one_time%& is set.
18990 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
18991 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18992 to make use of &%run%& items.
18995 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
18996 If this option is true, items of the form
18998 :include:<path name>
19000 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
19003 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
19004 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
19005 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
19006 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
19007 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
19010 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
19011 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
19012 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19015 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19016 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
19017 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
19018 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
19019 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
19024 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
19025 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
19026 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
19027 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
19028 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
19029 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
19030 bounce may well quote the generated address.
19033 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
19035 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19036 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
19037 file did not exist.
19040 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
19042 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19043 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
19044 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
19046 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
19047 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
19048 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
19049 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
19050 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
19051 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
19052 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
19053 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
19057 .option include_directory redirect string unset
19058 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
19059 redirection list must start with this directory.
19062 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
19063 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
19064 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
19067 .option one_time redirect boolean false
19068 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
19069 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
19070 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
19071 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
19072 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
19073 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
19074 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
19075 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
19076 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
19077 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
19078 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
19079 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
19080 before they subscribed.
19082 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
19083 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
19084 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
19085 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
19088 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
19089 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
19090 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
19091 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
19093 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
19094 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
19095 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
19097 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
19100 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
19101 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
19102 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
19103 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
19104 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
19108 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
19109 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
19110 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
19111 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
19112 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
19113 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
19114 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
19115 See &%check_owner%& above.
19118 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
19119 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
19120 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
19121 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
19124 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
19125 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
19126 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
19127 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
19128 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
19129 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
19130 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
19133 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
19134 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
19135 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
19136 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
19137 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
19138 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
19139 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
19140 &$qualify_recipient$&.
19142 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
19143 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
19144 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
19147 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
19148 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
19149 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
19150 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
19151 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
19152 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
19153 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
19154 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
19155 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
19156 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
19159 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
19160 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
19161 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
19162 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
19163 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
19164 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
19167 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
19168 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
19169 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
19170 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
19171 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
19172 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
19175 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
19176 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
19177 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
19178 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
19179 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
19182 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
19183 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
19184 :subaddress part of an address.
19186 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
19187 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
19188 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
19189 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
19192 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
19193 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
19194 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
19195 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
19196 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
19197 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
19198 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
19202 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
19203 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
19204 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
19205 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
19206 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
19207 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
19208 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
19209 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
19210 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
19211 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
19212 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
19213 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
19214 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
19215 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
19216 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
19217 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
19219 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
19220 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
19221 the following routers.
19223 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
19224 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
19225 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
19226 so it is passed to the following routers.
19228 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
19229 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
19230 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
19231 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
19233 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
19234 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
19235 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
19236 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
19242 file = $home/.forward
19243 file_transport = address_file
19244 pipe_transport = address_pipe
19245 reply_transport = address_reply
19248 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
19249 syntax_errors_text = \
19250 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
19251 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
19252 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
19253 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
19254 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
19255 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
19256 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
19257 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
19258 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
19259 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
19261 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
19262 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
19263 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
19268 local_part_prefix = real-
19269 transport = local_delivery
19271 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
19272 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
19274 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
19275 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
19279 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
19280 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19283 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
19284 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19285 .ecindex IIDredrou1
19286 .ecindex IIDredrou2
19293 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19294 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19296 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
19297 "Environment for local transports"
19298 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
19299 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
19300 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
19301 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
19302 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
19303 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
19304 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
19306 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
19307 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
19308 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
19309 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
19311 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
19312 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
19313 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
19314 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
19315 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
19319 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
19320 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
19321 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
19322 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
19323 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
19324 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
19325 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
19328 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
19329 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
19333 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
19335 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
19336 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
19337 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
19338 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
19343 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
19344 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19345 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
19346 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
19347 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
19348 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
19349 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
19350 group (set by the transport). For example:
19353 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
19357 transport = group_delivery
19360 # This transport overrides the group
19362 driver = appendfile
19363 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
19366 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
19367 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
19368 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
19371 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
19372 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
19373 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
19374 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
19375 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
19376 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
19378 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
19379 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
19380 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
19381 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
19382 original gid is also used.
19384 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
19385 following that is set is used:
19388 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
19390 A &%group%& setting of the router;
19392 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
19393 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
19395 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
19397 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
19398 the uid is the creator's uid;
19400 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
19403 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
19404 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
19405 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
19406 The first of the following that is set is used:
19409 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
19411 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
19413 A &%user%& setting of the router;
19415 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
19420 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
19421 &%never_users%& list.
19427 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
19428 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
19429 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19430 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
19431 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
19432 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
19433 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
19434 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
19435 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
19436 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
19439 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19441 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19443 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19445 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19448 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
19451 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
19453 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
19457 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
19458 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
19459 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
19463 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
19464 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19465 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19466 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
19467 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
19468 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
19469 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
19470 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
19471 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
19472 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
19473 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
19474 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
19475 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
19476 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
19484 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19485 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19487 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
19488 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
19489 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
19490 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
19491 The following generic options apply to all transports:
19494 .option body_only transports boolean false
19495 .cindex "transport" "body only"
19496 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
19497 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
19498 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
19499 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
19500 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
19501 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
19502 automatically suppress them.
19505 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
19506 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
19507 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
19508 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
19509 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19510 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19513 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
19514 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
19515 deliveries by the transport or for any
19516 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
19517 what you are doing.
19520 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
19521 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
19522 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
19523 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
19525 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
19526 output, and Exim carries on processing.
19527 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
19528 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
19529 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
19530 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
19534 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
19535 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
19536 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
19537 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
19538 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
19539 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
19540 safely be resent to other recipients.
19543 .option driver transports string unset
19544 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
19545 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
19548 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
19549 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19550 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
19551 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
19552 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
19553 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
19554 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
19555 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
19556 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
19557 resent to other recipients.
19560 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
19561 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
19562 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
19563 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
19564 &%user%& (see below).
19567 .option headers_add transports string&!! unset
19568 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
19569 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
19570 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded and added to the header
19571 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
19572 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
19573 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
19574 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
19575 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
19577 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
19578 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
19582 .option headers_only transports boolean false
19583 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
19584 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
19585 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
19586 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
19587 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
19588 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
19589 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
19592 .option headers_remove transports string&!! unset
19593 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
19594 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
19595 This option specifies a string that is expanded into a list of header names;
19596 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
19597 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
19598 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
19599 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
19600 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
19602 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
19603 for a router; all listed headers are added.
19607 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
19608 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
19609 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
19610 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
19611 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
19612 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
19613 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
19614 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
19617 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
19620 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
19621 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
19622 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
19623 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
19624 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
19625 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
19626 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
19627 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
19628 change envelope recipients at this time.
19631 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
19632 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
19634 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
19635 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
19636 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
19637 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
19638 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
19639 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
19640 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
19644 .option initgroups transports boolean false
19645 .cindex "additional groups"
19646 .cindex "groups" "additional"
19647 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
19648 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
19649 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
19650 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
19653 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
19654 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
19655 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
19656 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
19657 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
19658 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
19659 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
19660 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
19661 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
19662 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
19663 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
19664 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
19665 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
19670 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
19671 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
19672 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
19673 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
19674 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
19675 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
19676 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
19677 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
19680 local_part_prefix = *-
19682 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
19685 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
19687 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
19688 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
19689 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
19690 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
19691 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
19694 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
19695 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
19696 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
19697 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
19698 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
19699 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
19700 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
19701 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
19702 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
19704 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
19705 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
19706 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
19707 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
19709 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
19710 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
19711 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
19714 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
19715 .cindex "envelope sender"
19716 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
19717 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
19718 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
19719 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
19720 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
19721 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
19722 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
19723 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
19724 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
19726 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
19727 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
19729 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
19730 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
19731 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
19732 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
19733 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
19734 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
19735 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
19737 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
19738 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
19739 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
19740 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
19741 &%errors_to%& in a router.
19745 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
19746 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
19747 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
19748 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
19749 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
19750 have easy access to it.
19752 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
19753 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
19754 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
19755 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
19756 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
19760 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
19761 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
19764 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
19765 .cindex "shadow transport"
19766 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
19767 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
19768 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
19770 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
19771 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
19772 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
19773 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
19774 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
19775 cause a log line to be written.
19777 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
19778 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
19779 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
19780 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
19781 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
19784 ST=<shadow transport name>
19786 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
19787 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
19788 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
19789 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
19790 headers that some sites insist on.
19793 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
19794 .cindex "transport" "filter"
19795 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
19796 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
19797 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
19798 individual users or via a system filter.
19800 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
19801 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
19802 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
19803 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
19804 command must be specified as an absolute path.
19806 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
19807 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
19808 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
19809 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
19810 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
19811 &(pipe)& transports.
19813 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
19814 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
19815 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
19816 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
19817 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
19819 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
19820 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
19821 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
19822 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
19824 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
19825 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
19826 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
19827 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
19828 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
19829 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
19831 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
19832 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
19833 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
19834 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
19835 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
19836 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
19837 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
19838 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
19840 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19841 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
19842 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
19843 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
19844 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
19845 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
19846 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
19847 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
19848 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
19849 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
19852 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19853 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
19854 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
19855 which the message is being sent. For example:
19857 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
19858 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
19861 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
19862 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
19863 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
19865 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
19866 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
19867 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
19870 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
19872 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
19873 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
19874 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
19875 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
19876 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
19877 Exim tried to expand the first one.
19879 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
19880 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
19881 arguments. Consider this example:
19883 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19884 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19886 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
19887 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
19889 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19890 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19894 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
19895 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
19896 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
19897 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
19898 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
19899 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
19900 bounced from a transport filter.
19902 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
19903 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
19904 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
19907 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
19908 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
19909 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it a applies a timeout
19910 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
19911 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
19912 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
19913 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
19914 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
19915 becomes a temporary error.
19918 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
19919 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19920 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
19921 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
19922 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
19923 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
19924 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
19927 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
19928 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
19929 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
19931 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
19932 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
19933 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
19934 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
19936 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
19937 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
19938 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
19945 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19946 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19948 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
19950 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
19951 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
19952 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
19953 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
19954 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
19955 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
19956 copy of the message is delivered each time.
19958 .cindex "batched local delivery"
19959 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
19960 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
19961 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
19962 local transport, for example:
19965 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
19966 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
19967 recipients saves space.
19969 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
19970 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
19972 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
19973 to a scanner program or
19974 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
19978 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
19979 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
19980 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
19982 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
19983 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
19984 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
19985 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
19986 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
19987 to certain conditions:
19990 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19991 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
19992 batching is possible.
19994 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19995 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
19996 addresses with the same domain are batched.
19998 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
19999 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
20000 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
20001 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
20002 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
20005 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
20006 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
20007 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
20011 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
20012 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
20013 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
20014 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
20015 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
20016 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
20017 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
20020 escape_string = ".."
20022 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
20023 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
20024 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
20026 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20027 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
20028 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
20029 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
20030 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
20031 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
20033 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
20034 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20035 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
20036 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
20037 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
20038 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
20039 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
20040 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
20041 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
20046 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20047 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20049 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
20050 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
20051 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
20052 .cindex "directory creation"
20053 .cindex "creating directories"
20054 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
20055 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
20056 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
20057 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
20058 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
20059 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
20060 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
20061 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
20062 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
20063 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
20065 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
20066 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
20067 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
20070 .cindex "quota" "system"
20071 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
20072 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
20073 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
20075 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
20076 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
20077 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
20078 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
20080 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
20081 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
20084 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
20085 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
20086 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
20087 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
20092 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
20093 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
20094 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
20095 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
20096 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
20098 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20099 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20100 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
20101 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
20102 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
20103 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
20104 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
20105 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
20106 operation. There are two cases:
20109 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
20110 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
20111 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
20112 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
20113 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
20114 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
20115 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
20117 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
20118 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
20119 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
20123 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
20124 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
20125 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
20126 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
20131 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
20133 require "fileinto";
20134 fileinto "folder23";
20136 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
20137 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
20138 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
20139 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
20140 way of handling this requirement:
20142 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
20143 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
20144 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
20146 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
20150 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
20151 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
20152 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
20154 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
20155 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
20156 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
20157 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
20158 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
20159 path to the transport.
20161 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
20162 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
20167 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
20168 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
20172 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
20173 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
20174 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
20175 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
20176 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
20177 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
20178 delivery is deferred.
20181 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
20182 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20183 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20184 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
20185 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
20186 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
20187 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
20188 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
20191 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
20192 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20193 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
20194 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
20198 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
20199 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20202 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
20203 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
20204 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
20205 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
20206 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
20209 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
20210 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
20211 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
20212 process is running.
20215 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
20216 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20217 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
20218 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
20219 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
20220 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
20221 contains is significant.
20223 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
20224 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
20225 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
20226 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
20227 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
20229 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
20230 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
20231 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
20232 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
20233 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
20234 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
20236 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20237 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
20238 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20239 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20241 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
20242 .cindex "directory creation"
20243 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
20244 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
20245 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
20247 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
20248 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
20249 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
20250 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
20251 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
20255 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
20256 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
20257 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
20258 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
20259 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
20262 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
20263 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
20264 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
20265 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
20266 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
20267 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
20268 &%file_must_exist%&.
20271 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
20272 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
20273 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
20274 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
20276 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
20277 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
20278 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
20279 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
20280 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
20283 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
20285 .vindex "&$inode$&"
20286 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
20287 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
20288 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
20290 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
20292 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
20293 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
20297 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
20298 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
20299 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
20302 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
20303 See &%check_string%& above.
20306 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
20307 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
20308 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
20309 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
20310 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
20311 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
20314 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20315 .cindex "locking files"
20316 .cindex "lock files"
20317 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
20318 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
20320 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
20321 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
20324 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20325 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
20328 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
20329 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
20330 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
20331 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
20332 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
20333 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
20337 .option file_format appendfile string unset
20338 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
20339 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
20340 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
20341 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
20342 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
20343 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
20344 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
20345 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
20348 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
20349 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
20351 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
20352 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
20353 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
20354 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
20355 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
20356 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
20357 delivery is deferred.
20360 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
20361 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
20362 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
20363 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
20366 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
20367 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
20368 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
20369 .cindex "locking files"
20370 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
20371 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
20372 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
20373 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
20374 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
20375 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
20376 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
20377 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
20379 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
20380 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
20381 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
20382 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
20384 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
20385 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
20388 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
20390 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
20391 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
20392 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
20394 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
20395 local deliveries because of errors of the form
20397 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
20400 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
20401 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
20402 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
20403 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
20406 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
20407 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
20408 for details of locking.
20411 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
20412 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
20413 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
20416 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
20417 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
20418 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
20421 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
20422 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
20423 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
20424 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
20425 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
20428 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
20429 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
20430 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20431 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
20432 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
20433 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
20434 external source that maintains the data.
20437 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
20438 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
20439 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20440 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
20441 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
20442 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
20443 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
20444 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
20448 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
20449 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
20450 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
20451 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
20452 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
20453 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
20454 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
20455 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
20456 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
20457 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
20460 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
20461 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
20462 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
20463 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
20464 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
20465 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
20466 calculation. The default value is:
20468 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
20470 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
20471 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
20473 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
20475 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
20477 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
20478 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
20479 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
20480 directly into that directory.
20483 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
20484 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
20485 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
20488 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
20489 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
20490 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
20493 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
20494 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
20495 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
20496 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
20497 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
20498 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
20499 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
20500 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
20502 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
20503 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
20504 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
20505 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
20506 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
20507 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
20508 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
20509 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
20510 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
20511 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
20514 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
20515 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
20516 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
20517 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
20518 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
20519 below for further details.
20522 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
20523 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
20524 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
20527 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
20528 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
20529 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
20532 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
20533 .cindex "locking files"
20534 .cindex "file" "locking"
20535 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
20536 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
20537 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20538 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
20539 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
20540 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
20541 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
20543 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
20544 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
20545 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
20552 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
20553 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
20554 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
20555 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
20556 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
20557 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
20558 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
20559 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
20561 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
20562 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
20563 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
20564 append messages to it.
20567 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
20568 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20569 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
20570 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
20571 in which case it is:
20573 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
20574 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
20576 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20577 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
20579 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
20580 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
20581 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
20582 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
20587 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20588 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
20590 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
20591 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
20592 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
20593 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
20594 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
20595 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
20596 value, and this option is ignored.
20599 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
20600 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
20601 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
20602 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
20603 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
20606 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
20607 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
20608 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
20609 on users about incoming mail.
20612 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
20613 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
20614 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
20615 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
20616 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
20617 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
20618 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
20619 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
20620 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
20622 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
20623 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
20624 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
20626 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
20627 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
20628 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
20629 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
20630 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
20631 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
20633 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
20634 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
20635 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
20636 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
20639 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
20641 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
20642 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
20643 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
20644 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
20645 system quota failures.
20647 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
20648 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
20649 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
20650 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
20651 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
20652 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
20653 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
20654 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
20655 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
20656 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
20659 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
20660 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
20661 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
20662 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
20663 delivery directory.
20666 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
20667 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
20668 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
20669 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
20670 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
20674 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
20675 See &%quota%& above.
20678 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
20679 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
20680 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
20681 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
20682 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
20683 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
20684 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
20686 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
20687 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
20688 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
20689 the file length to the file name. For example:
20691 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
20692 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
20694 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
20695 number of lines in the message.
20697 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
20698 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
20699 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
20701 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
20704 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
20705 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
20706 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
20708 quota_warn_message = "\
20709 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
20710 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
20711 This message is automatically created \
20712 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
20713 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
20714 a warning threshold that is\n\
20715 set by the system administrator.\n"
20719 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
20720 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
20721 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
20722 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20723 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
20724 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
20725 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
20726 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
20727 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
20731 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
20733 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
20734 percent sign is ignored.
20736 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
20737 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
20738 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
20739 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
20740 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
20741 &'From:'& line, the default is:
20743 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
20745 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
20746 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
20749 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
20750 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
20754 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
20755 .cindex "envelope sender"
20756 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
20757 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
20758 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
20759 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
20760 for details of batch SMTP.
20763 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
20764 .cindex "carriage return"
20766 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
20767 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
20768 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
20769 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
20771 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
20772 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
20773 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
20774 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
20775 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
20776 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
20779 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20780 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
20781 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
20782 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
20783 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20784 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
20787 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
20788 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
20789 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
20790 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
20791 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
20793 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
20794 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
20795 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
20796 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
20798 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
20799 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
20800 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
20801 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
20802 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
20805 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
20806 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
20809 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
20810 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
20811 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
20812 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
20813 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
20814 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
20815 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
20817 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20818 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
20819 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
20820 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
20823 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
20824 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
20825 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
20828 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20829 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20830 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
20831 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
20832 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
20833 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
20834 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
20835 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
20836 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
20838 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20839 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
20840 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
20841 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
20846 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
20847 .cindex "appending to a file"
20848 .cindex "file" "appending"
20849 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
20852 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
20856 .cindex "directory creation"
20857 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
20858 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
20859 &%directory_mode%& option.
20862 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
20863 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
20867 .cindex "file" "locking"
20868 .cindex "locking files"
20869 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20870 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
20871 reliably over NFS, as follows:
20874 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
20875 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
20876 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
20878 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
20880 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
20881 Unlink the hitching post name.
20883 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
20884 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
20885 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
20886 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
20888 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
20889 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
20890 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
20891 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
20892 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
20893 it before trying again.
20897 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
20898 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
20899 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
20902 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20903 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20904 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
20905 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
20906 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
20907 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
20908 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
20909 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
20910 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
20914 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
20915 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
20916 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
20917 delivery is deferred.
20920 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
20921 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
20922 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
20926 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
20927 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
20928 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
20931 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
20932 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
20933 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
20936 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
20937 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
20938 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
20939 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
20940 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
20941 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
20942 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
20943 that prevents link following.
20946 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
20947 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
20948 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
20949 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
20950 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
20953 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
20956 .cindex "file" "locking"
20957 .cindex "locking files"
20958 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
20959 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
20960 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
20961 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
20962 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
20964 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
20966 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
20967 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
20968 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
20970 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
20971 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
20972 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
20974 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
20975 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
20976 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
20977 delivery is deferred.
20979 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
20980 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
20981 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
20982 immediately. It retries up to
20984 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
20986 times (rounded up).
20989 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
20990 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
20993 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
20994 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
20995 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20996 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
20997 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
20998 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
20999 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
21000 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
21001 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
21002 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
21004 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
21005 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
21006 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
21007 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
21008 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
21009 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
21010 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
21012 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
21013 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
21014 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
21015 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
21018 .cindex "maildir format"
21019 .cindex "mailstore format"
21020 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
21021 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
21022 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
21023 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
21024 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
21026 .cindex "directory creation"
21027 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
21028 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
21029 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
21030 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
21031 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
21032 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
21037 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
21038 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
21039 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
21040 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
21041 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
21042 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
21043 &_new_& subdirectory.
21045 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
21046 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
21047 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
21048 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
21049 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
21050 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
21051 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
21053 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
21054 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
21055 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
21056 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
21057 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
21058 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
21059 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
21060 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
21062 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
21063 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
21064 folders. Consider this example:
21066 maildir_format = true
21067 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
21068 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
21069 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
21070 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
21072 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
21073 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
21074 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
21075 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
21076 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
21077 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
21079 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
21080 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
21081 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
21082 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
21083 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
21085 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
21086 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
21087 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
21089 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21090 .cindex "maildir++"
21091 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
21092 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
21093 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
21094 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
21095 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
21096 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
21097 amount of space used.
21099 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
21100 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
21101 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
21102 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
21103 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
21104 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
21109 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
21110 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
21111 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
21112 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
21113 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
21114 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
21117 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
21118 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
21119 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
21120 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
21121 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
21122 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
21123 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
21124 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
21125 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
21126 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
21127 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
21128 backwards compatibility).
21130 For one common implementation, you might set:
21132 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
21134 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
21136 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
21137 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
21138 &[stat()]& each message file.
21141 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
21142 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21143 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21144 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
21145 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
21146 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
21147 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
21148 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
21149 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
21151 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
21152 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
21153 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
21154 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
21155 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
21156 need to know the quota.
21158 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
21159 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
21161 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
21162 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
21163 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
21167 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
21168 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
21169 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
21170 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
21171 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
21172 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
21173 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
21174 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
21176 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
21177 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
21178 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
21179 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
21180 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
21181 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
21183 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
21184 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
21185 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
21186 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
21187 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
21188 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
21190 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
21191 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
21192 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
21193 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
21196 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
21197 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
21198 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
21199 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
21200 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
21202 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
21204 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
21205 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
21206 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
21207 .ecindex IIDapptra1
21208 .ecindex IIDapptra2
21215 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21216 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21218 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
21219 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
21220 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
21221 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
21222 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
21223 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
21224 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
21225 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
21227 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
21228 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
21229 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
21230 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
21231 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
21234 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
21235 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
21236 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
21237 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
21238 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
21240 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
21241 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
21242 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
21243 transport is run as a consequence of a
21245 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
21246 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
21247 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
21248 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
21249 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
21250 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
21252 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
21253 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
21254 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
21255 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
21257 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
21258 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
21259 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
21260 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
21261 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
21262 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
21263 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
21265 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
21266 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
21267 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
21268 the transport defers.
21269 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
21270 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
21272 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
21273 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
21274 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
21275 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
21277 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
21278 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
21279 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
21280 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
21281 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
21282 problems. They are just discarded.
21286 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
21287 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
21289 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
21290 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
21291 message when the message is specified by the transport.
21294 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
21295 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
21296 when the message is specified by the transport.
21299 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
21300 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
21301 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
21302 string comes first.
21305 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
21306 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
21307 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
21310 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
21311 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
21312 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
21315 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
21316 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
21317 specified by the transport.
21320 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
21321 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
21322 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
21323 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
21326 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
21327 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
21328 the message is specified by the transport.
21331 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
21332 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
21336 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
21337 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
21338 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
21339 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
21340 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
21344 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
21345 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
21346 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
21347 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
21349 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
21350 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
21351 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
21352 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
21353 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
21354 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
21355 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
21358 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
21359 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
21360 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
21361 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
21362 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
21364 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
21365 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
21366 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
21367 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
21368 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
21369 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
21372 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
21373 See &%once%& above.
21376 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
21377 See &%once%& above.
21378 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
21381 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
21382 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
21383 specified by the transport.
21386 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
21387 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
21388 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
21389 configuration option.
21392 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
21393 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
21394 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
21395 automatic responses. For example:
21397 subject = Re: $h_subject:
21399 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
21400 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
21401 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
21402 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
21407 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
21408 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
21409 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
21410 the text comes first.
21413 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
21414 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
21415 when the message is specified by the transport.
21416 .ecindex IIDauttra1
21417 .ecindex IIDauttra2
21422 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21423 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21425 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
21426 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
21427 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
21428 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
21429 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
21430 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
21432 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
21433 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
21434 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
21435 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
21436 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
21437 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
21441 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
21442 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
21443 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
21446 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
21447 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21450 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
21451 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21452 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
21453 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
21454 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21457 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
21458 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
21459 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
21460 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
21461 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
21462 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
21465 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
21466 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
21467 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
21468 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
21469 in its response to the LHLO command.
21471 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
21472 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
21473 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
21474 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
21477 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
21478 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
21479 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
21480 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
21485 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
21489 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
21490 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
21494 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21495 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21497 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
21498 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
21499 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
21500 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
21501 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
21502 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
21503 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
21504 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
21508 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21509 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
21510 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
21511 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
21512 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
21514 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21515 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
21516 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
21517 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
21518 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
21519 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
21520 that are routed to the transport.
21522 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21523 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
21524 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
21525 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If only
21526 one address is being transported (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or
21527 only one address was redirected to this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains
21528 the local part that was redirected.
21532 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
21533 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
21534 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
21536 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
21537 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
21538 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
21539 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
21540 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
21541 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
21542 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
21545 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
21546 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
21547 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
21548 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
21549 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
21554 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
21555 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
21556 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
21557 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
21558 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
21559 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
21560 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
21561 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
21562 &"local delivery failed"&.
21564 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
21565 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
21566 will be sent as normal.
21568 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
21569 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
21570 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
21571 apply in this case.
21573 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
21574 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
21575 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
21576 a non-existent command may be the problem.
21578 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
21579 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
21580 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
21581 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
21582 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
21583 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
21584 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
21589 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
21590 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
21591 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
21592 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
21593 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
21596 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
21597 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
21598 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
21599 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
21601 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
21602 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
21603 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
21604 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
21605 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
21607 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
21609 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
21610 arguments. You have to write
21612 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
21614 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
21615 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
21616 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
21617 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
21618 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
21619 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
21622 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
21625 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21626 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21627 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21628 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
21629 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
21630 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
21631 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
21632 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
21633 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
21634 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
21636 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
21637 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
21638 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
21639 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
21640 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
21641 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
21642 control what is done with it.
21644 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
21645 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
21646 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
21647 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
21648 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
21649 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
21650 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
21651 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
21652 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
21653 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
21654 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
21658 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
21659 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
21660 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
21661 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
21662 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
21663 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
21666 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
21667 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
21668 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
21669 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
21670 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
21671 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
21672 &`LOGNAME `& see below
21673 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
21674 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
21675 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
21676 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
21677 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
21678 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
21679 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
21680 &`USER `& see below
21682 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
21683 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
21684 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
21685 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
21686 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
21687 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
21688 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
21691 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
21692 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
21693 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
21697 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
21698 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
21699 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
21700 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
21703 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
21704 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
21708 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
21709 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
21710 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
21711 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
21712 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
21713 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
21714 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
21715 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
21716 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
21717 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
21718 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
21721 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
21723 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
21724 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
21725 &%use_shell%& is set.
21728 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
21729 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21732 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
21733 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21734 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21737 .option check_string pipe string unset
21738 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
21739 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
21740 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
21741 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
21742 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
21743 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
21744 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
21748 .option command pipe string&!! unset
21749 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
21750 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
21751 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
21752 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
21753 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
21754 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
21757 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
21758 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
21759 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
21760 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
21761 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
21762 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
21763 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
21766 .option escape_string pipe string unset
21767 See &%check_string%& above.
21770 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
21771 .cindex "exec failure"
21772 .cindex "failure of exec"
21773 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
21774 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
21775 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
21776 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
21777 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
21780 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
21781 .cindex "signal exit"
21782 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
21783 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
21784 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
21785 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
21788 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
21789 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
21790 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
21791 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
21792 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
21793 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
21795 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
21796 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
21798 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
21799 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
21800 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
21801 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
21802 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
21805 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
21806 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
21807 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
21808 &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
21809 written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
21810 Only one of them may be set.
21814 .option log_output pipe boolean false
21815 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
21816 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
21817 &%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21821 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
21822 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
21823 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
21824 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
21825 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
21826 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
21827 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
21828 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
21831 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
21832 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21833 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
21836 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
21840 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
21841 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21842 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
21843 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
21844 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
21849 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21850 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21853 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
21854 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21855 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
21856 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
21860 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21861 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21864 .option path pipe string "see below"
21865 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
21866 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
21870 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
21871 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
21872 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
21875 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
21876 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
21877 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
21878 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
21879 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
21880 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
21881 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
21882 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
21883 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
21886 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
21887 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21888 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
21889 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
21890 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
21891 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
21892 accept the message is used.
21895 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
21896 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
21897 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
21898 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
21899 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
21900 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
21903 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
21904 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
21905 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
21906 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
21907 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
21908 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
21909 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21913 .option return_output pipe boolean false
21914 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
21915 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
21916 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
21917 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
21918 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
21919 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
21920 of them may be set.
21924 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
21925 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
21926 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
21927 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
21928 and &%return_output%& is not set,
21929 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
21930 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
21931 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
21932 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
21933 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
21934 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
21935 and 73, respectively.
21938 .option timeout pipe time 1h
21939 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
21940 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
21941 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
21942 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
21943 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
21944 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
21946 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
21947 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
21948 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
21949 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
21950 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
21951 delivery to be deferred.
21953 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
21954 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
21957 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
21958 .cindex "envelope sender"
21959 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
21960 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
21961 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
21962 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
21963 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
21965 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
21966 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
21967 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
21968 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
21969 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
21970 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
21974 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
21975 .cindex "carriage return"
21977 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21978 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21979 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
21980 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21982 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
21983 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
21984 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
21985 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
21986 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21989 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
21990 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21991 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
21992 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
21993 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
21994 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
21995 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
21996 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
21997 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
22002 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
22003 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
22004 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
22005 .cindex "external local delivery"
22006 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
22007 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
22008 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
22009 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
22010 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
22011 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
22012 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
22013 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
22014 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
22015 configuration for &%procmail%&:
22020 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
22024 check_string = "From "
22025 escape_string = ">From "
22034 transport = procmail_pipe
22036 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
22037 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
22038 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
22039 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
22040 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
22041 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
22043 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
22047 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
22048 use a shell to run pipe commands.
22051 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
22052 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
22055 local_delivery_cyrus:
22057 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
22058 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
22070 local_part_suffix = .*
22071 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
22073 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
22074 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
22076 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
22077 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
22080 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22081 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22083 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
22084 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
22085 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
22086 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
22087 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
22088 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
22089 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
22090 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
22093 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
22094 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
22098 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
22099 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
22100 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
22101 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
22102 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
22103 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
22104 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
22106 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
22107 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
22108 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
22109 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
22110 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
22111 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
22116 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
22117 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
22118 no further messages are sent over that connection.
22122 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
22124 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22125 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
22126 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
22127 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
22128 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
22129 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
22130 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
22131 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
22134 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
22135 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
22136 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
22137 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
22138 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
22139 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
22140 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
22141 are the values that were set when the message was received.
22142 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
22143 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
22144 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
22145 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
22146 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
22147 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
22149 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
22150 and will be removed in a future release.
22153 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
22154 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
22155 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
22158 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
22159 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
22160 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
22161 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
22162 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
22163 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
22164 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
22165 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
22167 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
22168 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
22169 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
22170 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
22171 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
22172 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
22173 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
22174 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
22175 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
22178 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
22180 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
22181 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
22182 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
22183 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
22184 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
22187 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
22188 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
22189 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
22190 particular connection.
22192 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
22193 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
22194 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
22195 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
22197 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
22198 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
22199 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
22201 authenticated_sender = $local_part
22203 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
22204 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
22206 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
22207 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
22211 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
22212 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
22213 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
22214 authenticated as a client.
22217 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
22218 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
22219 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
22220 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
22223 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
22224 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
22225 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
22226 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
22227 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
22228 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
22229 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
22232 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
22233 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
22234 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
22235 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
22236 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
22237 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
22238 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
22242 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
22243 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
22244 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
22245 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
22248 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
22249 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
22250 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
22253 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
22254 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
22255 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
22256 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
22257 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
22258 unhappy at this prospect, so...
22260 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
22261 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
22262 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
22263 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
22264 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
22265 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
22266 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
22267 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
22271 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
22272 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
22273 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
22274 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
22275 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
22278 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
22279 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
22280 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
22281 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
22286 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
22287 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
22288 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
22289 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
22290 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
22291 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
22292 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
22294 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
22295 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
22296 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
22297 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
22298 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
22302 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
22303 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
22304 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
22305 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
22306 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
22307 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
22308 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
22309 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
22311 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
22312 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
22313 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
22314 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
22315 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
22316 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
22318 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
22319 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
22320 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
22321 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
22322 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
22324 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
22325 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
22326 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
22327 copy of the message is sent.
22329 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
22330 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
22331 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
22332 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
22336 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
22337 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
22338 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
22341 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
22342 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
22343 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
22344 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
22345 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
22346 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
22348 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
22349 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
22350 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
22351 implementations of TLS.
22353 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
22354 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
22355 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
22356 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
22357 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
22358 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
22359 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
22364 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
22365 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
22366 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
22367 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
22368 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
22369 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
22370 interface address, you could use this:
22372 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
22373 {$primary_hostname}}
22375 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
22378 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
22379 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
22380 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
22381 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
22382 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
22383 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
22385 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
22386 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
22387 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
22388 &%hosts_override%& is set.
22390 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
22391 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
22392 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
22393 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
22394 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
22395 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
22396 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
22398 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
22399 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
22400 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
22401 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
22402 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
22403 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
22404 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
22407 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
22408 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
22411 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
22412 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
22413 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
22414 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
22415 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
22416 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
22417 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
22418 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
22419 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
22420 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
22423 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
22424 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
22425 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
22426 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
22429 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22430 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
22431 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
22432 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22434 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
22435 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
22436 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
22437 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
22438 to any host that matches this list.
22439 Note that the default is to not use TLS.
22442 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
22443 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
22444 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
22445 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
22446 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
22447 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
22448 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
22449 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
22452 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
22453 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
22454 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
22459 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22460 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
22461 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
22462 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
22463 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
22464 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
22465 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
22466 explanation of when this might be needed.
22469 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
22470 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
22471 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
22472 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
22473 &%fallback_hosts%&.
22476 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
22477 .cindex "randomized host list"
22478 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
22479 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
22480 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
22481 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
22482 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
22483 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
22484 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
22485 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
22487 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
22488 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
22489 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
22490 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
22492 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
22494 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
22495 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
22496 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
22498 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
22499 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
22500 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
22501 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
22502 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
22503 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
22504 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
22505 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
22506 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
22509 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22510 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
22511 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
22512 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22513 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
22514 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
22516 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
22517 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
22518 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
22519 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
22520 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
22521 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
22522 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
22524 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
22525 .cindex "bind IP address"
22526 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
22528 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22529 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
22530 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
22531 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
22532 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
22533 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
22534 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
22535 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
22538 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
22539 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
22540 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
22541 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
22542 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
22543 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
22545 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
22547 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
22548 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
22549 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
22550 interface to use if the host has more than one.
22553 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
22554 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
22555 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
22556 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
22557 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
22558 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
22559 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
22560 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
22561 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
22562 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
22566 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
22567 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22568 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
22569 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
22570 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
22572 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
22573 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
22574 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
22575 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
22576 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
22580 .option multi_domain smtp boolean true
22581 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22582 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
22583 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
22584 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
22585 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
22586 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
22587 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
22590 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
22591 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
22592 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
22593 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
22594 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
22595 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
22596 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
22597 variable that contains an outgoing port.
22599 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
22600 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
22601 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
22602 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
22607 .option protocol smtp string smtp
22608 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
22609 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
22610 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
22612 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
22613 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
22614 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
22615 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
22616 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
22618 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default vaule for the &%port%& option
22619 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
22620 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
22621 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
22624 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean true
22625 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
22626 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
22627 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
22628 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
22629 addresses is not affected.
22631 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
22632 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
22633 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
22634 Exim to use only the host name. This should normally be done on a separate
22635 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, set up specially to handle the dialup
22639 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
22640 .cindex "serializing connections"
22641 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
22642 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
22643 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
22644 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
22645 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
22646 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
22647 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
22649 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
22650 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
22651 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
22652 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
22653 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
22654 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
22656 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
22657 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
22658 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
22659 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
22660 are used for ETRN serialization.
22663 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
22664 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
22665 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
22666 .cindex "size" "of message"
22667 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22668 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22669 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
22670 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
22671 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
22672 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
22673 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
22674 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
22676 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
22677 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
22680 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
22681 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
22682 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
22684 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22685 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
22686 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
22687 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
22688 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
22691 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
22692 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
22693 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
22694 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
22698 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
22699 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
22700 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
22701 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
22702 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
22706 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
22707 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
22708 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
22709 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
22710 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
22711 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
22714 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
22718 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
22719 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
22721 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22722 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
22723 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
22724 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
22725 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22726 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
22727 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
22728 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22731 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
22732 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
22733 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
22735 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22736 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
22737 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
22738 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
22739 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22740 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
22741 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
22742 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
22743 ciphers is a preference order.
22747 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
22748 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
22749 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
22750 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
22751 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
22752 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
22753 certificate and private key for the session.
22755 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
22757 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
22763 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
22764 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
22765 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
22766 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
22767 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
22768 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
22769 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
22770 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
22771 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
22772 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
22776 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! unset
22777 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
22778 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
22780 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22781 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
22782 permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
22783 Alternatively, if you are using OpenSSL, you can set
22784 &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a directory containing certificate
22785 files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the option must be set to the name of a
22786 single file if you are using GnuTLS. The values of &$host$& and
22787 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22788 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22793 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
22795 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
22796 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
22797 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
22798 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
22799 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
22802 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
22803 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
22804 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
22805 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
22808 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
22809 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
22810 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
22812 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
22813 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
22814 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
22815 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
22816 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
22818 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
22819 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
22820 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
22821 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
22822 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
22823 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
22824 see below for an exception).
22826 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
22827 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
22828 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
22829 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
22830 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
22832 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
22833 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
22834 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
22835 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
22836 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
22837 reached their retry times.
22839 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
22840 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
22841 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
22842 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
22843 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
22844 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
22845 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
22846 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
22847 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
22848 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
22851 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
22852 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
22853 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
22854 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
22855 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
22856 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
22858 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
22859 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
22860 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
22861 possible IP addresses have been tried.
22862 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
22863 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
22869 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22870 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22872 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
22873 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
22874 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
22875 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
22876 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
22877 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
22879 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
22880 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
22881 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
22882 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
22883 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
22884 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
22885 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
22887 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
22888 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
22889 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
22890 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
22893 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
22894 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
22895 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
22896 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
22898 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
22899 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
22900 facility; you do not have to use it.
22902 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
22903 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
22904 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
22905 address to which it applies.
22907 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
22908 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
22909 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
22910 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
22911 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
22912 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
22915 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
22916 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
22917 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
22918 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
22921 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
22922 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
22923 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
22924 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
22925 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
22928 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
22929 illustrated by these examples:
22932 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
22933 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
22934 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
22935 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
22937 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
22938 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
22943 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
22944 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
22945 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
22946 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
22947 message's processing.
22949 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22950 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
22951 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
22952 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
22953 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
22954 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
22955 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
22956 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
22957 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
22959 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22960 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22961 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
22962 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
22963 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
22964 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
22965 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
22966 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
22967 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
22968 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
22970 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
22971 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
22972 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
22973 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
22974 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
22975 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
22977 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
22978 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
22979 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
22981 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
22982 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22983 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
22984 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
22985 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
22986 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
22987 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
22988 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
22989 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
22991 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
22992 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
22998 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
22999 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
23000 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
23001 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
23002 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
23003 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
23004 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
23005 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
23006 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
23007 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
23009 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
23011 might produce the output
23013 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23014 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23015 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23016 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23017 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23018 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23019 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23020 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23022 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
23023 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
23024 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
23025 set for a particular transport.
23028 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
23029 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
23030 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
23033 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
23035 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
23036 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
23037 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
23038 any colons must be doubled, of course).
23040 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
23041 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
23042 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
23043 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
23046 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
23047 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
23048 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
23050 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
23051 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
23052 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
23053 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
23054 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
23055 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
23056 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
23058 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23059 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23060 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
23061 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
23062 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
23066 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
23067 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
23070 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
23071 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
23072 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
23073 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
23074 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
23075 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
23076 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
23077 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
23078 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
23080 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
23081 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
23082 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
23084 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
23085 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
23086 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
23087 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
23088 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
23089 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
23090 of pattern they are set as follows:
23093 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
23094 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
23095 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
23098 *queen@*.fict.example
23100 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
23102 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
23106 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
23107 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
23110 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
23111 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
23112 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
23113 rewriting rule of the form
23115 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
23117 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
23123 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
23124 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
23125 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
23126 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
23127 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
23131 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
23132 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
23133 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
23134 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
23135 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
23137 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
23139 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
23142 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23143 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23144 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
23145 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
23146 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
23147 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
23148 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
23149 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
23150 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
23151 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
23152 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
23153 entry written to the panic log.
23157 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
23158 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
23161 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
23164 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
23166 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
23169 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
23170 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
23174 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
23176 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
23177 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
23178 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
23179 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
23180 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
23181 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
23183 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
23184 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
23185 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
23186 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
23187 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
23188 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
23189 &`h`& rewrite all headers
23190 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
23191 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
23192 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
23194 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
23195 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
23196 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
23198 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
23199 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
23202 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
23203 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
23204 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
23205 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
23206 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
23207 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
23208 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
23209 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
23210 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
23212 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23213 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23214 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
23215 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
23216 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
23217 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
23218 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
23219 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
23222 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
23223 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
23224 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
23225 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
23228 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
23229 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
23230 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
23232 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
23233 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
23234 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
23235 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
23237 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
23238 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
23239 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
23241 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
23242 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
23243 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
23244 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
23246 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
23250 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
23253 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
23254 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
23255 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
23256 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
23257 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
23258 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
23259 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
23260 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
23262 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
23263 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
23267 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
23268 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
23270 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
23271 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
23272 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
23274 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
23275 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
23276 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
23277 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
23278 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
23279 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
23280 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
23281 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
23283 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
23284 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
23286 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
23288 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
23289 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
23291 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
23292 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
23293 messages that originate outside the local host:
23295 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
23296 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
23298 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
23301 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
23302 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
23303 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
23304 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
23305 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
23306 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
23307 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
23308 components. For example, the rule
23310 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
23312 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
23313 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
23314 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
23315 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
23316 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
23317 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
23318 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
23325 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23326 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23328 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
23329 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
23330 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
23331 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
23332 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
23333 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
23334 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
23335 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
23336 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
23337 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
23338 address, domain and error.
23340 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
23341 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
23342 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
23343 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
23344 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
23345 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
23346 log selector is set, the message
23347 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
23348 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
23349 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
23350 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
23352 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
23353 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
23354 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
23355 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
23356 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
23357 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
23358 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
23359 domain are maintained independently.
23361 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
23362 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
23363 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
23364 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
23365 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
23366 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
23367 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
23368 the local address is reached.
23370 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
23371 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
23372 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
23373 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
23374 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
23376 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
23377 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
23378 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
23379 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
23380 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
23381 messages that it should now be retaining.
23385 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
23386 .cindex "retry" "rules"
23387 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
23388 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
23389 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
23390 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
23391 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
23392 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
23393 message's sender, respectively.
23396 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
23397 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
23398 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
23399 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
23400 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
23401 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
23404 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23406 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
23409 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23411 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
23412 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
23415 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
23416 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a routing rule pattern, it
23417 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
23418 expressions work in address lists.
23420 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
23421 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
23425 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
23426 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
23427 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
23428 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
23429 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
23430 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
23431 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
23432 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
23433 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
23435 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
23436 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
23437 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
23438 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
23441 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
23442 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
23443 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
23444 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
23445 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
23446 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
23447 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
23448 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
23449 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
23450 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
23455 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
23457 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
23458 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
23459 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
23460 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
23461 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
23462 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
23464 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
23468 and the retry rules are
23470 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
23471 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
23473 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
23474 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
23475 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
23476 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
23477 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
23478 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
23480 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
23481 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
23482 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
23483 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
23485 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
23486 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
23487 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
23489 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
23491 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
23492 textual form of the IP address.
23494 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
23495 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
23496 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
23497 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
23500 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
23501 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
23502 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
23504 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
23505 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
23506 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
23508 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
23509 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
23511 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
23512 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
23515 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
23516 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
23517 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
23518 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
23519 retry rule of this form:
23521 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
23523 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
23524 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
23527 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
23528 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
23529 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
23530 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
23532 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
23533 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
23535 .vitem &%refused_A%&
23536 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
23539 A connection was refused.
23541 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
23542 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
23544 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
23545 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
23547 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
23548 A connection attempt timed out.
23550 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
23551 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
23552 obtained from an MX record.
23554 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
23555 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
23556 obtained from an MX record.
23559 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
23561 .vitem &%tls_required%&
23562 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
23563 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
23564 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
23567 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
23570 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
23571 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
23572 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
23573 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
23574 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
23575 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
23579 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
23580 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
23581 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
23582 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
23583 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
23587 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
23588 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
23589 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
23591 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
23592 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
23593 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
23594 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
23595 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
23596 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
23597 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
23599 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
23600 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
23603 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
23604 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
23605 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
23610 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
23611 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
23612 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
23613 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
23614 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
23617 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
23619 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
23621 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
23623 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
23624 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
23627 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
23629 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
23630 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
23631 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
23632 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
23633 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
23635 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
23636 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
23638 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
23640 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
23641 list is never matched.
23647 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
23648 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
23649 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
23650 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
23652 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
23654 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
23655 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
23656 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
23657 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
23658 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
23660 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
23661 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
23662 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
23663 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
23664 The available algorithms are:
23667 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
23670 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
23671 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
23672 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
23674 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
23675 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
23676 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
23677 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
23678 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
23679 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
23680 queue processing times.
23683 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
23684 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
23685 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
23686 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
23687 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
23688 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
23689 interval is found. The main configuration variable
23690 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
23691 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
23692 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
23693 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
23694 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
23696 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
23697 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
23698 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
23699 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
23700 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
23701 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
23704 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
23705 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
23706 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
23707 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
23708 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
23709 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
23710 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
23711 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
23712 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
23713 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
23714 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
23715 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
23717 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
23718 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
23719 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
23720 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
23721 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
23722 deliveries that have been deferred.
23725 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
23726 Here are some example retry rules:
23728 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
23729 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
23730 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
23731 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23732 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
23733 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
23735 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
23736 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
23737 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
23738 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
23739 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
23740 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
23741 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
23744 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
23745 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
23746 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
23747 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
23748 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
23750 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
23751 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
23752 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
23753 were not obtained from an MX record.
23755 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
23756 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
23757 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
23758 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
23759 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
23763 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
23764 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
23765 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
23766 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
23767 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
23768 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
23769 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
23770 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
23771 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
23772 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
23773 failing for the first time.
23775 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
23776 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
23777 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
23778 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
23780 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
23781 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
23782 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
23787 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
23788 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
23789 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
23790 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
23791 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
23792 default retry rule:
23794 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
23796 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
23797 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
23798 failure for the recipient address that counts.
23800 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
23801 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
23802 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
23803 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
23804 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
23806 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
23807 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
23808 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
23810 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
23811 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
23812 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
23813 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
23814 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
23815 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
23816 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
23817 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
23819 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
23820 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
23821 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
23822 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
23823 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
23826 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23827 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
23828 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23829 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
23830 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
23831 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
23832 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
23833 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
23834 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
23837 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
23838 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
23839 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
23840 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
23841 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
23842 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
23843 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
23844 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
23847 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
23848 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
23849 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
23850 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
23851 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
23852 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
23853 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
23854 time out the address.
23856 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
23857 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
23858 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
23859 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
23860 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
23861 considered immediately.
23862 .ecindex IIDretconf1
23863 .ecindex IIDregconf2
23870 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23871 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23873 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
23874 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
23875 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
23876 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
23877 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
23878 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
23879 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
23880 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
23881 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
23884 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
23885 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
23888 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
23889 the client's EHLO command.
23891 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
23892 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
23894 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
23895 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
23896 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
23897 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
23898 with the AUTH command.
23900 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
23902 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
23903 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
23904 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
23907 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
23908 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
23909 unauthenticated connection.
23912 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
23913 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
23914 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
23915 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
23917 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
23918 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
23919 &`Connected to server.example.`&
23920 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
23921 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
23922 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
23923 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
23924 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
23929 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
23930 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
23931 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
23932 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
23933 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
23934 included by setting
23937 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
23940 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
23944 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
23945 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
23946 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
23947 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
23948 work via a socket interface.
23949 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
23950 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
23951 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
23952 supporting setting a server keytab.
23953 The sixth can be configured to support
23954 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
23955 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
23956 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
23958 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
23959 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
23960 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
23961 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
23962 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
23963 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
23964 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
23966 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
23967 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
23968 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
23969 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
23970 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
23971 both sets of options, is required. For example:
23975 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23976 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
23978 client_secret = secret2
23980 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
23981 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
23983 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
23984 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
23985 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
23988 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
23989 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
23990 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
23991 authenticating data.
23993 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
23994 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
23995 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
23996 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
23997 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
23998 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
23999 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
24000 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
24001 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
24002 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
24005 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
24006 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
24007 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
24008 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
24012 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
24013 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
24014 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
24016 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24017 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
24018 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
24019 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
24020 encrypted by a setting such as:
24022 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
24026 .option driver authenticators string unset
24027 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
24028 authenticators is to be used.
24031 .option public_name authenticators string unset
24032 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
24033 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
24034 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
24035 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
24036 defaults to the driver's instance name.
24039 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24040 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
24041 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
24042 mechanism is not advertised.
24043 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
24044 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
24045 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
24048 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24049 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
24050 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
24053 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
24054 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
24056 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
24057 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
24058 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
24059 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
24060 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
24061 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
24062 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
24063 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
24064 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
24068 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
24069 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
24070 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
24071 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
24072 out the values of variables.
24073 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
24074 output, and Exim carries on processing.
24077 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
24078 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24079 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
24080 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
24081 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
24082 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
24083 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
24084 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
24085 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
24088 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24089 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
24090 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
24091 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
24092 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
24093 remembered for later use.
24094 How it is used is described in the following section.
24100 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
24101 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
24102 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
24103 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
24104 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
24108 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
24109 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
24111 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
24113 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
24114 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
24115 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
24116 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
24117 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
24118 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
24119 given for the MAIL command.
24121 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
24122 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
24125 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
24126 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
24127 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
24128 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
24129 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
24130 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
24131 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
24136 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
24137 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
24138 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
24139 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
24141 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24142 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
24143 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
24144 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
24145 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
24150 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
24151 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
24152 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
24153 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
24157 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
24159 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
24160 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
24163 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
24164 the mechanisms are advertised.
24166 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
24167 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
24168 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
24169 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
24170 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
24171 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
24172 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
24174 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
24176 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
24178 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
24179 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
24180 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
24183 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
24185 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
24186 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
24187 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
24189 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
24190 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
24191 command. This is the case if
24194 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
24196 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
24198 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
24199 server authenticators.
24203 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
24204 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
24205 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
24207 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
24208 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
24209 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
24210 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
24211 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
24212 rejected with a 504 error.
24214 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
24215 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
24216 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
24217 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
24218 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
24219 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
24220 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
24221 no successful authentication.
24226 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
24227 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
24228 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
24229 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
24230 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
24231 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
24232 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
24236 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
24238 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
24239 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
24240 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
24241 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
24242 command line to run this script on such data might be
24244 encode '\0user\0password'
24246 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
24247 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
24248 whose code value is zero.
24250 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
24251 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
24252 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
24253 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
24255 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
24256 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
24257 example, a command such as
24259 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
24261 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
24263 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
24264 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
24266 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
24268 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
24269 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
24270 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
24271 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
24275 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
24276 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
24277 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
24278 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
24279 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
24280 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
24283 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
24284 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
24285 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
24286 of the authenticator.
24289 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24290 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
24291 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
24292 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
24293 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
24294 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
24295 delivery to be deferred.
24297 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
24298 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
24299 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
24302 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
24303 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
24304 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
24305 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
24306 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
24307 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
24308 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
24309 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
24310 deliver the message unauthenticated.
24313 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
24314 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
24315 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
24316 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
24317 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
24318 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
24319 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
24320 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
24321 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
24322 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
24323 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
24324 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
24325 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
24332 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24333 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24335 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
24336 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
24337 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
24338 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
24339 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
24340 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
24341 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
24342 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
24343 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
24344 connections as you do for login accounts.
24346 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
24347 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
24348 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
24350 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24351 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
24352 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
24354 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
24355 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
24356 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
24359 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
24360 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24361 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24362 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
24363 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24364 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
24365 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24367 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
24368 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
24369 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
24370 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
24371 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
24372 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
24373 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
24375 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
24376 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
24377 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
24378 string expansions that also use them for other things.
24380 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
24381 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
24382 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
24384 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24385 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
24386 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
24387 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
24388 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
24389 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
24390 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
24391 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
24392 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
24393 string as the error text.
24395 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
24396 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
24397 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
24401 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
24402 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
24403 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
24404 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24405 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
24406 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
24407 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
24408 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
24410 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
24411 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
24412 configured as follows:
24416 public_name = PLAIN
24418 server_condition = \
24419 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
24420 server_set_id = $auth2
24422 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
24423 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
24424 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
24425 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
24427 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
24428 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
24429 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
24430 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
24434 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
24436 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
24438 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
24439 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
24443 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
24444 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
24446 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
24447 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
24448 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
24449 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
24450 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
24452 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
24453 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
24454 authenticating clients it could make sense.
24456 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
24457 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
24458 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
24459 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
24460 This is an incorrect example:
24462 server_condition = \
24463 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
24465 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
24466 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
24467 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
24468 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
24469 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
24470 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
24471 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
24473 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
24474 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
24476 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
24477 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
24478 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
24479 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
24480 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
24483 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
24484 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
24485 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
24486 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
24487 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
24488 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
24489 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
24493 public_name = LOGIN
24494 server_prompts = User Name : Password
24495 server_condition = \
24496 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
24497 server_set_id = $auth1
24499 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
24500 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
24501 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
24502 strings are used to obtain two data items.
24504 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
24505 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
24506 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
24507 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
24508 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
24512 public_name = LOGIN
24513 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
24514 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
24517 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
24518 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
24519 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
24520 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
24522 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
24523 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
24524 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
24525 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
24526 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
24527 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
24528 uninterpreted string.
24531 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
24532 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
24533 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
24534 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
24535 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
24541 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
24542 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
24543 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
24545 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
24546 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
24547 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
24548 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
24551 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
24552 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
24553 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
24554 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
24555 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
24556 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
24557 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
24558 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
24559 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
24560 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
24561 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
24562 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
24564 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
24565 splitting takes priority and happens first.
24567 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
24568 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
24569 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
24570 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
24573 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
24574 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
24578 public_name = PLAIN
24579 client_send = ^username^mysecret
24581 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
24582 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
24583 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
24587 public_name = LOGIN
24588 client_send = : username : mysecret
24590 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
24591 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
24593 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
24594 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
24599 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24600 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24602 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
24603 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
24604 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
24605 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
24606 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
24607 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
24608 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
24609 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
24610 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
24611 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
24612 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
24613 available in plain text at either end.
24616 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
24617 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
24618 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
24619 authenticator as a server:
24621 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
24622 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
24623 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
24624 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
24625 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
24626 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
24627 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
24628 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
24629 returned to the client.
24631 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
24632 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
24633 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
24634 numeric variables for other things.
24636 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
24637 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
24638 user name, authentication fails.
24642 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24643 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
24644 server_set_id = $auth1
24646 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24647 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
24648 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
24649 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
24653 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24654 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
24656 server_set_id = $auth1
24658 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
24659 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
24661 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
24662 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
24663 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
24668 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24669 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
24670 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}}
24671 server_set_id = $auth1
24674 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
24675 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
24676 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
24680 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
24681 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
24682 computing the response to the server's challenge.
24685 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
24686 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
24687 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
24691 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24692 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
24693 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
24694 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
24695 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
24696 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
24697 send the message to the current server.
24699 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
24704 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24706 client_secret = secret
24708 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
24709 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
24713 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24714 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24716 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
24717 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
24718 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
24719 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
24721 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
24722 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
24724 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
24725 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
24726 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
24727 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
24728 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
24730 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
24731 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
24732 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
24733 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
24735 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
24736 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
24737 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
24738 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
24739 depending on the driver you are using.
24741 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
24742 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
24743 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
24744 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
24745 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
24748 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
24749 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
24750 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
24751 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
24752 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
24753 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
24754 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
24755 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
24758 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
24759 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
24760 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
24761 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
24762 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
24763 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
24767 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
24768 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
24769 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
24770 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
24773 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
24774 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
24775 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
24776 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
24780 driver = cyrus_sasl
24781 public_name = X-ANYTHING
24782 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
24783 server_set_id = $auth1
24786 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
24787 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
24790 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
24791 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
24794 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
24795 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
24796 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
24797 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
24800 driver = cyrus_sasl
24801 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24802 server_set_id = $auth1
24805 driver = cyrus_sasl
24806 public_name = PLAIN
24807 server_set_id = $auth2
24809 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
24810 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
24811 but it is present in many binary distributions.
24812 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
24813 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
24818 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24819 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24820 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
24821 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
24822 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
24823 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
24824 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
24825 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
24826 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
24827 authenticator only. There is only one option:
24829 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
24831 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
24832 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
24833 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
24834 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
24838 public_name = PLAIN
24839 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
24840 server_set_id = $auth2
24845 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
24846 server_set_id = $auth1
24848 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
24849 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
24850 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
24851 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
24852 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
24853 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
24854 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
24855 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
24858 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24859 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24860 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
24861 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
24862 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
24863 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
24864 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
24865 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
24866 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
24867 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
24868 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
24869 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
24870 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
24871 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
24872 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
24873 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
24874 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
24875 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
24876 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
24877 without code changes in Exim.
24880 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
24881 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
24882 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
24883 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
24884 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
24887 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
24888 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
24889 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
24891 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
24892 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
24893 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
24895 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
24896 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
24897 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
24900 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
24901 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
24902 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
24903 Some mechanisms will use this data.
24906 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
24907 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
24908 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
24909 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
24914 public_name = X-ANYTHING
24915 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
24916 server_set_id = $auth1
24920 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
24921 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
24922 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
24923 the password itself.
24925 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
24926 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
24927 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
24928 if available, else the empty string.
24929 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
24930 else the empty string.
24932 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
24934 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
24935 option to be simply "true".
24938 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
24939 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
24940 Some mechanisms will use this data.
24943 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
24944 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
24945 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
24946 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
24949 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
24950 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
24951 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
24952 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
24955 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
24956 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
24957 Some mechanisms will use this data.
24960 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
24961 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
24962 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
24963 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
24965 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
24966 meanings for these variables:
24969 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
24970 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
24972 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
24973 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
24975 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
24976 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
24979 On a per-mechanism basis:
24982 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
24983 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
24984 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
24986 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
24987 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
24988 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
24990 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
24991 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
24992 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
24993 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
24996 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
24997 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
24998 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
25001 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
25002 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
25004 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
25006 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25007 server_realm = imap.example.org
25008 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
25009 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
25010 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
25011 server_condition = yes
25015 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25016 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25018 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
25019 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
25020 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
25021 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
25022 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
25023 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
25024 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
25027 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
25028 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
25029 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
25030 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
25032 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
25033 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
25034 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
25035 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
25037 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
25038 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
25039 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifer for finding credentials
25043 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
25044 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
25045 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
25046 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
25048 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
25049 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
25050 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
25051 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
25053 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25055 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
25056 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
25058 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
25059 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
25060 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
25065 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25066 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25068 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
25069 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
25070 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
25071 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
25072 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
25073 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
25074 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
25075 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
25076 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
25077 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
25078 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
25079 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
25080 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
25084 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
25085 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
25087 The server sends back a challenge.
25089 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
25090 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
25093 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
25097 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
25098 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
25099 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
25101 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
25102 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
25103 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
25104 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
25105 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
25106 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
25107 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
25108 for other things. For example:
25113 server_password = \
25114 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
25116 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
25117 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
25123 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
25124 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
25125 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
25129 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
25130 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
25133 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
25134 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
25137 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
25138 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
25139 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
25145 client_username = msn/msn_username
25146 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
25147 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
25149 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
25150 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
25156 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25157 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25159 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
25160 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
25161 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
25162 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
25163 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
25166 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
25167 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
25168 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
25169 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
25170 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
25171 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
25172 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
25173 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
25174 certificates are used.
25176 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
25177 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
25178 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
25179 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
25180 between them is encrypted.
25182 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
25183 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
25184 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
25185 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
25188 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
25189 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
25190 in order to get TLS to work.
25194 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
25196 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
25197 .cindex "smtps protocol"
25198 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
25199 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
25200 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
25201 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
25202 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
25203 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
25204 allocated for this purpose.
25206 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
25207 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
25208 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
25209 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
25211 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
25213 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
25214 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
25215 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
25216 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
25217 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
25220 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
25221 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
25228 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
25229 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
25230 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
25231 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
25232 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
25236 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
25240 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
25241 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
25243 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
25246 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must contain the name of a file, not the
25247 name of a directory (for OpenSSL it can be either).
25249 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
25251 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
25252 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
25253 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
25254 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
25255 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
25257 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
25258 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
25259 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
25260 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
25261 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
25262 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
25263 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
25266 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
25267 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
25270 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
25271 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
25272 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
25273 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
25276 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
25277 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
25278 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
25279 implementation, then patches are welcome.
25283 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
25284 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
25285 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
25286 but not the chosen filename.
25287 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
25288 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
25290 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
25291 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
25292 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
25293 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
25295 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
25296 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
25297 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
25298 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
25299 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
25300 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
25301 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
25303 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
25304 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
25305 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
25306 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
25307 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
25309 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
25310 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
25311 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
25312 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
25313 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
25314 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
25316 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
25317 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
25318 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
25320 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
25321 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
25322 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
25323 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
25326 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
25329 # chown exim:exim new-params
25330 # chmod 0600 new-params
25331 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
25332 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
25333 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
25334 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
25335 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
25336 # chmod 0400 new-params
25337 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
25339 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
25340 stalling is removed.
25342 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
25343 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
25344 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
25345 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
25346 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
25347 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
25348 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
25349 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
25350 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
25351 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
25352 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
25354 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
25355 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
25356 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
25357 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
25359 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
25360 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
25361 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
25362 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
25363 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
25366 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
25367 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
25368 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
25369 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
25370 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
25371 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
25372 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
25373 directly to this function call.
25374 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
25375 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
25376 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
25377 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
25380 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
25382 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
25383 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
25384 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
25387 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
25388 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
25389 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
25393 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
25396 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
25397 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
25400 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
25401 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
25403 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
25404 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
25407 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
25408 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
25409 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
25410 not be moved to the end of the list.
25413 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
25416 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
25417 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
25420 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
25421 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
25422 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
25423 choice of clients used:
25425 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
25426 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
25433 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
25435 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
25436 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
25437 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
25438 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
25439 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
25440 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
25441 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
25442 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
25443 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
25444 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
25446 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string.
25448 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
25449 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
25450 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
25451 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
25452 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
25453 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
25455 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
25456 "Priority strings". This is online as
25457 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
25458 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
25459 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
25460 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/manual/html_node/Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string.html, then the example code)
25461 on that site can be used to test a given string.
25463 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
25464 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
25465 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
25467 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
25468 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
25469 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
25470 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
25474 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
25480 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
25481 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
25482 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
25483 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
25484 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
25485 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
25486 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
25487 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
25489 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
25490 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
25491 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
25494 554 Security failure
25496 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
25497 rejected with a 554 error code.
25499 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
25500 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
25501 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
25502 without some further configuration at the server end.
25504 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
25505 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
25507 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
25508 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
25510 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
25511 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
25512 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
25513 that goes with it. These files need to be readable by the Exim user, and must
25514 always be given as full path names. They can be the same file if both the
25515 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
25516 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
25517 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
25518 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
25519 the server's certificate.
25521 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
25522 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
25523 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
25525 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
25526 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
25527 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
25530 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
25531 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
25532 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
25534 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
25536 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
25537 with the parameters contained in the file.
25538 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
25543 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
25544 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
25545 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
25546 documetnation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
25552 for a way of generating file data.
25554 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
25555 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
25556 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
25557 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
25558 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
25560 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
25561 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
25562 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
25563 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
25564 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
25565 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
25566 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
25567 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
25568 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
25570 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
25571 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
25572 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
25573 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
25574 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
25575 documentation for more details.
25577 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
25578 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
25581 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
25582 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
25583 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
25584 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
25585 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
25586 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
25587 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
25588 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
25589 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
25590 expected certificates. These must be available in a file or,
25591 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, identified by
25592 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
25594 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
25597 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
25598 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
25599 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
25601 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
25603 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
25605 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
25606 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
25607 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
25608 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
25609 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
25610 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
25611 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
25612 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
25613 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
25614 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
25616 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
25617 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
25618 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
25619 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
25621 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
25622 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
25623 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
25624 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
25625 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
25626 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
25629 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
25630 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
25631 .cindex "revocation list"
25632 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
25633 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
25634 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
25635 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
25636 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
25637 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
25641 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
25642 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
25643 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
25644 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
25645 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
25646 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
25647 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
25648 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
25649 within the &(smtp)& transport.
25651 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
25652 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
25653 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
25654 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
25655 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
25657 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
25658 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
25659 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
25660 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
25661 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
25664 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
25665 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
25666 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
25667 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
25668 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
25669 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
25670 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
25671 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
25672 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25673 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25676 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
25677 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
25678 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
25679 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
25681 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
25682 must name a file or,
25683 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
25684 expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
25685 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
25686 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
25689 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
25690 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
25691 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
25692 alternative hosts, if any.
25695 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
25696 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
25697 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
25701 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25702 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
25703 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
25704 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
25705 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
25707 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
25708 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
25709 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
25710 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
25711 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
25712 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
25713 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
25714 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
25715 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
25716 outgoing connection.
25720 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
25721 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
25722 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
25723 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
25724 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
25725 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
25726 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
25727 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
25728 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
25729 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
25732 This is analagous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
25733 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
25736 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
25737 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
25738 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
25739 be of limited use in that environment.
25741 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
25742 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
25743 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
25744 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
25745 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
25747 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
25748 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
25749 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
25750 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
25751 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
25753 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
25754 received from a client.
25755 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
25757 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
25758 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
25759 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
25762 .vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
25763 &%tls_certificate%&
25765 .vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
25768 .vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
25771 .vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
25772 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
25775 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
25776 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
25777 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
25778 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
25780 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
25783 When Exim is built againt OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
25784 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
25785 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
25786 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
25788 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
25789 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
25790 built, then you have SNI support).
25794 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
25796 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
25797 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25798 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
25799 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
25800 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
25801 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
25802 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
25803 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
25804 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
25805 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
25806 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
25808 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
25809 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
25810 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
25811 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
25812 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
25813 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
25814 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
25815 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
25816 and delay other deliveries to that host.
25818 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
25819 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
25820 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
25821 information is recorded.
25823 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
25824 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
25825 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
25830 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
25831 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
25832 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
25833 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
25834 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
25835 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
25836 to Apache, currently at
25838 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
25840 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
25841 links to further files.
25842 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
25843 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
25844 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
25846 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
25850 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
25851 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
25852 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
25853 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
25854 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
25855 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
25856 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
25857 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
25858 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
25859 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
25860 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
25861 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
25862 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
25865 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
25866 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
25867 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
25868 with OpenSSL, like this:
25870 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
25873 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
25874 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
25875 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
25876 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
25877 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
25878 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
25879 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
25881 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
25882 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
25883 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
25885 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
25886 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
25887 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
25888 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
25889 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
25890 signed with that self-signed certificate.
25892 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
25893 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
25894 Open-source PKI book, available online at
25895 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
25896 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
25897 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
25901 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25902 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25904 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
25905 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
25906 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
25907 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
25908 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
25909 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
25910 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
25911 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
25912 one very small ACL:
25916 accept hosts = one.host.only
25918 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
25919 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
25921 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
25922 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
25923 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
25924 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
25925 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
25926 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
25927 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
25928 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
25931 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
25932 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
25933 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
25934 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
25935 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
25939 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
25940 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
25941 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
25942 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
25943 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
25944 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
25945 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
25946 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
25947 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
25948 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
25949 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
25950 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
25951 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
25952 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
25953 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
25954 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
25955 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
25956 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
25959 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
25960 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
25961 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
25962 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
25963 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
25964 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
25965 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
25966 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
25967 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
25968 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
25969 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
25970 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
25971 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
25972 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
25973 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
25974 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
25975 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
25976 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
25979 For example, if you set
25981 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
25983 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
25984 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
25985 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
25986 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
25987 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
25988 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
25989 testing as possible at RCPT time.
25992 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
25993 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
25994 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
25995 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
25996 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
25997 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
25998 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
25999 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
26000 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
26001 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
26002 in any of these ACLs.
26004 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
26005 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
26006 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
26007 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
26008 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
26009 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
26010 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
26011 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
26013 control = suppress_local_fixups
26015 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
26016 run, it is too late.
26018 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26019 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26021 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
26022 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
26023 temporary error for these kinds of message.
26026 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
26027 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
26028 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
26029 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
26030 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
26031 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
26032 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
26033 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
26034 &%smtp_banner%& option.
26037 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
26038 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
26039 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
26040 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
26041 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
26042 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
26043 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
26044 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
26045 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
26047 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
26048 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
26049 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
26050 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
26054 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
26055 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
26056 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
26057 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
26058 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
26059 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
26060 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
26061 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
26062 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
26063 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
26065 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
26066 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
26067 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
26068 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
26069 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
26070 associated with the DATA command.
26072 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
26073 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
26074 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
26075 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
26076 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
26080 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
26081 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
26082 enabled (which is the default).
26084 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
26085 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
26086 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
26088 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHID12>>&.
26091 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
26092 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26093 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26096 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
26097 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
26098 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
26099 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
26100 does not in fact control any access. For this reason, the only verbs that are
26101 permitted are &%accept%& and &%warn%&.
26103 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
26104 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
26105 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
26106 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
26108 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
26109 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
26111 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
26112 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
26115 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
26116 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
26117 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
26118 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
26119 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
26122 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
26123 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
26124 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
26125 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is is bad
26126 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
26127 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
26128 situation even worse.
26130 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
26131 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
26132 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
26135 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
26136 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
26137 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
26138 connection. The possible values are:
26140 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
26141 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
26142 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
26143 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
26144 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
26145 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
26146 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
26147 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
26148 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
26149 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
26151 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
26152 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
26153 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
26154 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
26155 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
26159 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
26160 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
26161 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
26162 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
26164 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
26165 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
26167 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
26168 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
26169 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
26170 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
26171 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
26173 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
26174 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
26175 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
26178 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
26179 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
26180 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
26181 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
26182 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
26183 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
26185 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
26186 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
26187 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
26189 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
26190 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
26191 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
26192 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
26194 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
26195 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
26196 matches the string.
26198 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
26199 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
26200 want to have something like
26202 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
26204 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
26205 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
26211 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
26212 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
26213 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
26214 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
26215 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
26216 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
26217 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
26218 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
26219 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
26221 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
26222 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
26223 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
26226 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
26227 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
26228 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
26229 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
26231 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
26232 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
26233 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
26234 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
26235 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
26236 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
26237 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
26240 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
26241 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
26242 recipients; it may create new recipients.
26246 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
26247 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
26248 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
26249 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
26250 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
26251 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
26253 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
26254 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
26255 used to accept or reject anything.
26257 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
26258 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
26259 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
26260 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
26262 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
26263 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
26264 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
26265 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
26266 configuration file.
26271 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
26272 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
26274 .vindex &$local_part$&
26275 .vindex &$sender_address$&
26276 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
26277 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
26278 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
26279 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
26280 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
26281 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
26282 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
26283 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
26285 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
26286 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
26287 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
26290 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
26291 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
26292 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
26293 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
26294 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
26297 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
26298 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
26299 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
26300 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
26301 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
26302 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
26303 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
26304 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
26310 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
26311 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
26312 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
26313 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
26314 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
26315 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
26316 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
26317 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
26318 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
26319 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
26320 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
26321 unencrypted connections.
26324 accept encrypted = *
26325 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
26327 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
26329 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
26330 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
26331 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
26332 option to do this.)
26336 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
26337 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
26338 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
26339 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
26340 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
26341 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
26342 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
26344 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
26345 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
26346 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
26349 deny dnslists = list1.example
26350 dnslists = list2.example
26352 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
26353 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
26354 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
26355 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
26356 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
26359 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
26360 The ACL verbs are as follows:
26363 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
26364 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
26365 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
26366 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
26367 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
26368 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
26369 check a RCPT command:
26371 accept domains = +local_domains
26375 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
26376 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
26377 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
26378 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
26381 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
26382 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
26383 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
26386 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
26387 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
26388 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
26389 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
26390 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
26391 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
26393 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
26394 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
26396 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
26397 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
26398 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
26400 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
26401 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
26402 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
26407 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
26408 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
26409 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
26410 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
26411 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
26412 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
26413 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
26417 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
26418 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
26419 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
26422 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26424 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
26428 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
26429 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
26430 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
26431 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
26432 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
26433 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
26434 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
26435 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
26436 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
26438 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
26439 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
26440 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
26444 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
26445 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
26446 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
26448 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
26449 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
26451 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
26452 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
26455 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
26456 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
26457 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
26458 example, when checking a RCPT command,
26460 require message = Sender did not verify
26463 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
26464 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
26465 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
26466 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
26469 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
26470 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
26471 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
26472 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
26473 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
26474 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
26475 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
26477 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
26478 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
26479 &%logwrite%&, and &%add_header%&) that appear before the first failing
26480 condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
26481 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
26483 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
26484 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
26485 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
26486 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
26487 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
26488 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
26492 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
26493 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
26494 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
26495 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
26497 warn !verify = sender
26498 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
26502 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
26504 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
26505 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
26506 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
26507 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
26508 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
26512 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
26513 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
26514 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
26515 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
26516 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
26517 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
26518 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
26519 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
26520 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
26521 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
26523 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
26524 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
26525 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
26526 on the same SMTP connection.
26528 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
26529 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
26530 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
26533 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
26534 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
26535 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
26537 accept hosts = whatever
26538 set acl_m4 = some value
26539 accept authenticated = *
26540 set acl_c_auth = yes
26542 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
26543 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
26544 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
26546 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
26547 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
26548 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
26549 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
26550 error is generated.
26552 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
26553 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
26556 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
26557 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
26558 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
26559 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
26561 deny domains = *.dom.example
26562 !verify = recipient
26564 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
26565 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
26566 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
26567 two statements are equivalent:
26569 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
26570 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
26572 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
26573 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
26575 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
26576 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
26577 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
26579 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
26580 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
26581 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
26582 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
26584 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
26585 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
26586 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
26587 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
26588 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
26589 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
26590 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
26592 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
26593 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
26594 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
26595 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
26596 message is handled.
26598 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement important, because the
26599 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
26600 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
26601 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
26603 require message = Can't verify sender
26605 message = Can't verify recipient
26607 message = This message cannot be used
26609 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
26610 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
26611 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
26612 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
26613 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
26614 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
26616 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
26617 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
26618 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
26619 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
26622 !senders = *@my.domain.example
26623 message = Invalid sender from client host
26625 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
26626 by which time Exim has set up the message.
26630 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
26631 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
26632 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
26635 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26636 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
26637 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
26638 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
26640 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26641 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
26642 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
26643 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
26644 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
26645 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
26646 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
26647 write rather ugly lines like this:
26649 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
26651 Instead, all you need is
26653 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
26656 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26657 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
26658 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
26659 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
26660 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
26661 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
26662 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
26663 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
26665 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
26666 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
26667 in several different ways. For example:
26669 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
26670 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
26671 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
26675 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
26677 accept ...some conditions
26678 control = queue_only
26680 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
26681 other words, when the conditions are all true.
26684 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
26686 accept ...some conditions...
26687 control = queue_only
26688 ...some more conditions...
26690 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
26691 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
26692 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
26696 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
26697 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
26700 warn ...some conditions...
26704 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
26705 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
26709 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
26710 &%require%& verb. For example:
26712 require control = no_multiline_responses
26716 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
26717 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
26719 This modifier may appear in any ACL. It causes Exim to wait for the time
26720 interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the &%-bh%&
26721 option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is output
26722 instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay happens
26723 as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending output is
26724 flushed before the delay is imposed.
26726 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
26729 deny ...some conditions...
26732 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
26733 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
26736 ...some conditions...
26738 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
26739 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
26741 warn ...some conditions...
26747 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
26748 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
26749 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
26750 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
26751 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
26752 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
26753 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
26757 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
26758 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
26759 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
26760 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
26761 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
26762 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
26763 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
26766 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26767 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
26768 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
26769 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
26771 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
26772 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
26774 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
26777 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
26778 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
26780 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
26781 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
26782 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
26785 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
26786 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
26787 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
26788 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
26789 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
26790 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
26793 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
26794 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
26795 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
26798 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
26799 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
26800 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
26801 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
26802 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
26803 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
26805 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
26806 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
26807 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
26808 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
26809 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
26810 logging rejections.
26813 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
26814 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
26815 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
26816 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
26817 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
26818 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
26819 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
26820 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
26822 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
26823 &` log_reject_target =`&
26825 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
26826 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
26830 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26831 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
26832 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
26833 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
26834 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
26835 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
26836 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
26839 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
26840 &` control = freeze`&
26841 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
26843 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
26844 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
26845 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
26848 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
26849 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
26853 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26854 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
26855 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
26856 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
26857 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
26858 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
26859 &%accept%& for details.)
26861 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
26862 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
26863 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
26864 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
26865 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
26867 require message = Host not recognized
26870 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
26873 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
26874 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
26875 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
26876 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
26877 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
26878 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
26879 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
26880 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
26881 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
26884 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
26885 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
26886 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
26888 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
26889 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
26891 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
26892 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
26893 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
26896 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
26897 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
26899 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
26900 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
26901 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
26904 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
26905 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
26906 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
26907 However, the original message is available in the variable
26908 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
26909 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
26910 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
26911 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
26913 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
26914 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
26915 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
26916 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
26917 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
26918 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
26922 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
26923 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
26924 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
26925 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
26932 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
26933 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
26934 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
26937 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
26938 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
26939 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
26940 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
26941 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
26942 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
26943 not work without it. For example:
26945 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
26946 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
26948 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
26949 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
26950 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
26951 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
26952 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
26955 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
26956 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
26957 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
26958 .cindex "case of local parts"
26959 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26960 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
26961 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
26962 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
26963 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
26964 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
26967 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
26968 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
26969 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
26970 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
26971 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
26973 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
26974 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
26977 warn control = caseful_local_part
26978 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
26980 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
26982 control = caselower_local_part
26984 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
26985 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
26989 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery*&
26990 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
26991 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
26992 It is usable in the RCPT ACL and valid only for single-recipient mails forwarded
26993 from one SMTP connection to another. If a recipient-verify callout connection is
26994 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for the data, otherwise one is made
26995 after the ACL completes.
26997 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
26998 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
26999 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
27000 usual fashion. If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode the log line
27001 is tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appears before the acceptance "<="
27004 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a (possibly faked)
27005 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
27010 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
27011 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
27012 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
27013 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
27014 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
27015 strings or to numeric value.
27016 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
27017 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
27018 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
27020 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
27021 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
27022 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
27023 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
27024 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
27028 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
27029 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
27030 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
27031 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
27032 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
27033 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
27034 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
27035 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
27036 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
27040 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
27041 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
27042 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
27046 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
27047 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
27048 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
27049 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
27050 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
27051 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
27052 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
27053 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
27055 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
27056 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
27057 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
27058 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
27059 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
27060 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
27064 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
27065 .cindex "fake defer"
27066 .cindex "defer, fake"
27067 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
27068 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
27069 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
27070 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
27071 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
27073 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
27074 .cindex "fake rejection"
27075 .cindex "rejection, fake"
27076 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
27077 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
27078 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
27079 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
27080 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
27081 the same SMTP connection.
27083 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
27084 message is supplied, the following is used:
27086 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
27087 550-kept for evaluation.
27088 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
27089 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
27091 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
27093 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
27094 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
27095 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
27096 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
27097 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
27098 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
27101 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
27102 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
27103 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
27104 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
27106 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
27107 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
27108 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
27109 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
27110 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
27111 disables such output flushing.
27113 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
27114 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
27115 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
27116 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
27117 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
27118 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
27120 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
27121 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
27122 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
27123 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
27124 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
27125 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
27126 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
27127 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
27128 to be useful in production.
27130 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
27131 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
27132 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
27133 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
27134 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
27136 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
27137 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
27138 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
27139 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
27140 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
27141 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
27144 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
27145 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
27146 verification failed"&) is sent.
27148 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
27152 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
27153 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
27155 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
27156 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
27157 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
27158 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
27159 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
27160 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
27161 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
27163 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
27164 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
27165 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
27166 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
27167 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
27168 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
27169 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
27170 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
27171 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
27172 same SMTP connection.
27174 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
27175 .cindex "message" "submission"
27176 .cindex "submission mode"
27177 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
27178 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
27179 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
27180 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
27181 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
27182 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
27183 late (the message has already been created).
27185 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
27186 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
27187 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
27188 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
27189 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
27191 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
27192 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
27193 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
27194 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
27195 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
27198 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
27199 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
27201 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
27203 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
27206 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
27207 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
27208 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
27209 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
27212 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
27213 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
27217 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
27218 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
27221 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
27223 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
27224 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
27226 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
27228 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
27233 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
27234 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
27235 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
27236 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
27237 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
27238 to an incoming message, as in this example:
27240 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27241 dialup.mail-abuse.org
27242 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
27244 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
27245 MIME, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
27246 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
27247 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
27248 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
27251 If the data for the &%add_header%& modifier contains one or more newlines that
27252 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
27253 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
27254 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
27256 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
27257 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
27258 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
27259 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
27260 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
27261 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
27262 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
27263 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
27264 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
27265 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
27266 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
27268 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
27269 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until they are added to the
27270 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
27271 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
27272 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
27273 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
27274 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
27275 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
27276 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
27278 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately it is encountered during the
27279 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
27281 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
27282 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
27284 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
27285 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
27287 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
27288 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
27289 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
27290 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
27293 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
27294 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
27295 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
27296 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
27297 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
27298 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
27299 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
27302 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
27303 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
27304 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
27305 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
27306 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
27308 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
27309 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
27310 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
27311 to be a header name first.) For example:
27313 warn add_header = \
27314 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
27316 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
27317 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
27318 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
27319 up in reverse order.
27321 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
27322 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
27323 system filter or in a router or transport.
27328 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
27329 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
27330 Some of conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
27331 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
27332 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
27333 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27335 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
27336 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
27337 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
27338 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
27339 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
27340 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
27341 The conditions are as follows:
27345 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
27346 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
27347 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
27348 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
27349 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
27350 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
27351 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
27352 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
27353 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
27354 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
27355 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
27356 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
27358 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
27359 can be appended; they appear in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9, and $acl_narg is set
27360 to the count of values. The name and values are expanded separately.
27362 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
27363 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
27364 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
27365 conditions are tested.
27367 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
27368 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
27369 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
27370 for different local users or different local domains.
27372 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
27373 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
27374 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
27375 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
27376 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
27377 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
27378 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
27383 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
27384 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
27385 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
27386 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
27387 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
27388 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
27389 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
27390 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
27391 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
27392 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
27393 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
27394 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
27397 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
27398 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
27399 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27400 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
27401 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
27402 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
27403 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
27404 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27406 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
27407 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
27408 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27409 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
27410 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
27412 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
27413 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
27414 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
27415 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
27416 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
27417 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
27418 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
27419 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
27420 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
27421 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
27423 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
27424 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
27425 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
27426 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
27427 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
27428 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
27429 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
27430 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
27431 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
27434 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
27435 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
27438 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
27439 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
27440 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
27441 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
27442 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
27443 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
27444 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
27450 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'&~host&~list'&>
27451 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
27452 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
27453 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
27454 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
27455 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
27456 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
27458 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
27460 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
27461 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
27462 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
27464 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
27465 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
27466 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
27467 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
27468 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
27469 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
27471 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
27472 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
27474 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
27475 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
27477 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
27478 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
27479 statement can then check the IP address.
27481 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
27482 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
27483 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
27484 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
27486 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
27487 message = $host_data
27489 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
27491 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
27492 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
27493 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
27494 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
27495 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
27496 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
27497 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
27498 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
27499 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
27500 the next &%local_parts%& test.
27502 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
27503 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
27504 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
27505 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
27506 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27507 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
27508 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27510 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
27511 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
27512 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
27513 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27514 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
27515 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
27516 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
27519 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
27520 .cindex "rate limiting"
27521 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
27522 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
27524 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
27525 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
27526 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
27527 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
27528 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
27529 recipient address against a list of recipients.
27531 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
27532 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
27533 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
27534 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27535 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
27536 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
27537 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27539 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
27540 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
27541 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
27542 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
27543 .vindex "&$domain$&"
27544 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
27545 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
27546 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
27547 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
27548 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
27549 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
27550 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
27551 influence the sender checking.
27553 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
27554 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
27556 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
27557 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
27558 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
27559 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
27560 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
27561 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
27565 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
27566 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
27568 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
27569 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
27570 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
27571 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27572 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
27573 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27575 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
27576 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27577 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
27578 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
27579 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
27580 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
27581 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
27582 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
27583 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
27584 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27586 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
27587 .cindex "CSA verification"
27588 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
27589 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
27590 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
27592 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
27593 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27594 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
27595 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
27596 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
27597 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
27598 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
27599 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
27600 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
27601 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
27602 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
27603 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
27604 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
27605 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
27606 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
27608 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
27609 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
27610 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
27611 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
27614 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
27615 !verify = header_sender
27618 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
27619 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27620 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
27621 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
27622 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
27623 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
27624 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
27625 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
27626 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
27627 and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
27628 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
27629 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
27632 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
27633 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
27637 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
27638 common as they used to be.
27640 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
27641 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27642 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
27643 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
27644 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
27645 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
27646 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
27647 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
27648 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
27649 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
27650 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
27651 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
27652 independently of this condition.
27654 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
27655 option), this condition is always true.
27658 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
27659 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
27660 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
27661 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
27662 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
27663 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
27664 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
27665 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
27666 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
27668 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
27669 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
27672 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
27673 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27674 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
27675 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
27676 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
27677 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
27678 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
27679 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
27680 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
27681 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
27682 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
27683 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
27684 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
27685 value for the child address.
27687 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup*&
27688 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27689 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
27690 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
27691 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
27692 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
27693 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
27694 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
27695 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
27696 original IP address.
27698 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
27699 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
27701 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
27702 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27703 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
27704 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
27705 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
27706 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
27707 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
27708 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
27709 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
27711 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
27712 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
27713 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
27714 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
27715 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
27716 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
27717 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
27719 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
27720 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
27721 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
27723 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
27724 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27725 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
27726 verified as a sender.
27731 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
27732 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
27733 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
27734 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
27735 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
27736 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
27737 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
27738 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
27739 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
27740 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
27742 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
27743 dialups.mail-abuse.org
27745 the following records are looked up:
27747 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27748 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
27750 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
27751 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
27752 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
27753 use two separate conditions:
27755 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27756 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
27758 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
27759 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
27760 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
27763 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
27764 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
27765 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
27766 following special items in the list:
27768 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
27769 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
27770 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
27772 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
27773 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
27774 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
27775 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
27777 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
27779 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
27780 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
27782 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27783 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
27784 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
27786 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
27787 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
27788 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
27789 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
27793 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
27794 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
27795 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
27796 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
27797 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
27799 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
27801 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
27802 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
27803 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
27804 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
27809 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
27810 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
27811 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
27812 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
27813 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
27814 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
27815 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
27817 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
27818 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
27820 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
27821 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
27822 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
27823 up by this example is
27825 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
27827 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
27828 addresses. For example:
27830 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27831 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
27833 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
27834 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
27839 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
27840 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
27841 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
27842 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
27843 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
27844 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
27845 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
27846 either to double the separators like this:
27848 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
27850 or to change the separator character, like this:
27852 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
27854 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
27855 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
27856 occurs. Consider this condition:
27858 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
27860 The DNS lookups that occur are:
27862 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
27863 a.domain.black.list.tld
27865 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
27866 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
27867 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
27868 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
27869 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
27870 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
27871 error for a previous item.
27873 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
27874 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
27876 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
27877 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
27879 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
27880 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
27882 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
27883 $sender_address_domain \
27884 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
27886 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
27887 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
27888 $sender_address_domain} }} }
27890 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
27891 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
27892 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
27893 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
27895 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
27897 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
27898 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
27900 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
27901 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
27906 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
27907 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
27908 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
27909 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
27910 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
27911 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
27915 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
27917 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
27918 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
27919 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
27921 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
27922 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
27923 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
27926 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
27927 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
27928 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
27929 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
27930 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
27931 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
27932 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
27933 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
27934 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
27935 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
27936 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
27937 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
27938 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
27939 cases, for example:
27941 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
27943 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
27944 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
27945 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
27946 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
27948 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
27950 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
27951 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
27953 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
27954 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
27955 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
27956 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
27957 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
27960 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
27961 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
27962 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
27964 deny hosts = !+local_networks
27965 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
27967 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
27972 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
27973 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
27974 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
27975 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
27978 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
27980 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
27981 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
27982 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
27983 describes how multiple records are handled.
27985 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
27986 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
27987 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
27989 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
27991 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
27992 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
27993 first. For example:
27995 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
27996 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
27999 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
28000 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
28001 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
28002 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
28003 tested. For example:
28005 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
28007 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
28008 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
28009 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
28011 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
28013 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
28018 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
28019 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
28022 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28024 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
28025 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
28027 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28029 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
28030 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
28031 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
28032 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
28034 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
28035 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
28037 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
28038 previous example is precisely equivalent to
28040 deny dnslists = a.b.c
28041 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28043 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
28044 Consider this example:
28046 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28048 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
28051 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
28053 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28055 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
28056 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
28057 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
28059 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
28064 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
28065 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
28066 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
28067 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
28068 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
28069 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
28071 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
28073 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
28074 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
28075 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
28076 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
28077 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
28078 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
28081 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
28082 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
28083 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
28085 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
28086 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
28089 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
28091 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
28092 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
28094 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
28096 for the condition to be true.
28099 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
28100 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
28102 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
28103 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
28105 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
28107 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
28108 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
28110 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true there is at least one
28111 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
28113 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
28115 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
28116 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
28118 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
28120 for the condition to be false.
28122 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
28123 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
28128 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
28129 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
28130 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
28131 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
28132 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
28133 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
28134 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
28135 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
28136 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
28139 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
28140 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
28141 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
28142 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
28143 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
28144 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
28145 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
28148 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
28149 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
28151 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
28152 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
28154 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
28155 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
28156 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
28157 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
28158 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
28159 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
28161 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
28162 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
28163 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
28165 reject dnslists = \
28166 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
28167 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
28168 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
28169 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
28171 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
28172 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
28173 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
28177 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
28178 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
28179 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
28180 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
28181 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
28182 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
28184 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
28185 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28187 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
28188 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
28189 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
28191 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
28193 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
28194 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
28196 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
28197 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
28199 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
28200 dnslists = some.list.example
28203 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
28204 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
28205 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
28206 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
28207 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
28208 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
28209 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
28210 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
28211 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
28212 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
28214 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
28216 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
28217 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
28219 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
28220 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
28221 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
28224 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
28225 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
28226 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
28227 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
28228 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
28229 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
28230 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
28231 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
28232 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
28234 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
28235 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
28236 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
28237 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
28239 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
28240 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
28241 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
28242 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
28243 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
28244 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
28245 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
28246 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
28247 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
28248 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
28250 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
28251 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
28252 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
28255 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
28256 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
28257 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
28258 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
28259 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
28260 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
28262 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
28263 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
28264 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
28265 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
28266 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
28267 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
28268 the &%count=%& option.
28271 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
28272 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
28273 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
28274 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
28275 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
28277 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
28278 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
28279 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
28280 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
28282 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
28283 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
28284 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
28285 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
28286 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
28287 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
28288 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
28290 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
28291 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
28292 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
28293 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
28294 ACLs the rate is updated with the total recipient count in one go. Note that
28295 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
28296 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
28298 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
28299 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
28300 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
28301 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
28304 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
28305 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
28306 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
28307 multiple different commands.
28309 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
28310 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
28311 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
28312 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
28313 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
28315 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
28318 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
28319 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
28320 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
28321 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
28322 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
28324 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
28325 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
28327 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
28328 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
28329 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
28330 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
28334 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
28335 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
28336 (max $sender_rate_limit)
28339 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
28340 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
28341 (max $sender_rate_limit)
28344 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
28345 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
28346 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
28347 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
28348 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
28349 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
28352 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
28353 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
28354 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
28355 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
28356 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
28359 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
28360 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
28361 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
28362 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
28363 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
28364 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
28367 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
28368 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
28369 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
28370 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
28371 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
28372 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
28373 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
28374 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
28375 from getting any email through.
28377 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
28378 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
28379 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
28380 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
28381 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
28382 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
28383 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
28384 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
28386 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
28390 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
28391 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
28392 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
28393 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
28394 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
28395 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
28396 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
28397 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
28398 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
28400 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
28401 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
28402 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
28403 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
28404 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
28405 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
28407 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
28408 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
28411 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
28412 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
28413 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
28414 required increases with larger limits.
28416 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
28417 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
28418 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
28419 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
28420 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
28421 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
28422 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
28423 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
28424 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
28428 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
28429 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
28430 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
28431 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
28432 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
28433 message. For example:
28435 # Log all senders' rates
28436 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
28437 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
28439 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
28440 # at the decimal point.
28441 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
28442 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
28443 $sender_rate_limit }s
28445 # Keep authenticated users under control
28446 deny authenticated = *
28447 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
28449 # System-wide rate limit
28450 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
28451 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
28453 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
28454 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
28455 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
28456 messages per $sender_rate_period
28457 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
28458 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
28459 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
28461 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
28462 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
28463 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
28464 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
28465 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
28466 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
28467 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
28471 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
28472 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
28473 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
28474 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
28475 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
28476 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
28477 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
28478 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
28479 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
28481 verify = sender/callout
28482 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
28484 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
28485 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
28486 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
28487 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
28488 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
28489 The available options are as follows:
28492 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
28493 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
28494 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
28496 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
28497 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
28498 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
28499 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
28501 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
28502 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
28504 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
28505 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
28506 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
28507 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
28510 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
28511 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
28512 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
28513 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28514 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
28515 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
28518 warn !verify = sender
28519 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
28521 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
28522 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
28523 verification failure.
28525 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
28526 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
28529 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
28530 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
28532 &%route%&: Routing failed.
28534 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
28535 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
28536 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
28538 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
28540 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
28543 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
28544 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
28549 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
28550 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
28551 .cindex "callout" "verification"
28552 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
28553 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
28554 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
28555 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
28556 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
28557 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
28558 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
28559 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
28560 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
28563 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
28564 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
28565 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
28566 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
28567 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
28568 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
28570 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
28571 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
28572 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
28573 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
28574 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
28576 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
28577 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
28578 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
28579 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
28580 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
28581 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
28582 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
28583 supplies a host list.
28585 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
28586 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
28587 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
28588 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
28589 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
28590 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
28591 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
28593 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
28594 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
28595 following SMTP commands are sent:
28597 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
28599 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
28602 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
28605 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
28606 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
28607 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
28608 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
28609 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
28610 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
28612 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
28613 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
28614 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
28615 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
28616 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
28618 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
28619 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
28620 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
28621 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
28622 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
28627 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
28628 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
28629 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
28630 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
28632 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
28634 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
28635 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
28636 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
28640 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
28641 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
28642 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
28645 verify = sender/callout=5s
28647 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
28648 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
28649 the &%connect%& parameter.
28652 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
28653 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
28654 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
28655 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
28657 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
28659 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
28661 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
28662 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
28663 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
28664 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
28665 updated in this circumstance.
28667 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
28668 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
28669 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
28670 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
28671 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
28672 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
28675 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
28676 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
28677 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
28678 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
28679 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
28680 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
28681 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
28682 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
28683 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
28684 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
28686 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
28688 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
28691 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
28692 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
28693 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
28696 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
28698 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
28699 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
28700 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
28701 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
28702 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
28705 .vitem &*no_cache*&
28706 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
28707 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
28708 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
28710 .vitem &*postmaster*&
28711 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
28712 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
28713 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
28714 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
28715 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
28716 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
28717 made, until the cache record expires.
28719 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
28720 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
28721 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
28724 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
28726 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
28727 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
28729 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
28731 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
28732 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
28733 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
28734 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
28738 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
28739 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
28740 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
28741 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
28742 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
28744 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
28746 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
28747 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
28748 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
28749 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
28750 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
28752 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
28753 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
28754 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
28756 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
28758 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
28759 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
28760 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
28761 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
28762 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
28764 .vitem &*use_sender*&
28765 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
28767 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
28769 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
28770 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
28771 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
28772 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
28773 usefulness of callout caching.
28776 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
28777 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
28778 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
28779 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
28780 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
28781 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
28782 these circumstances.
28784 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
28785 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
28786 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
28787 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
28788 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
28789 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
28790 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
28792 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
28793 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
28794 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
28795 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
28800 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
28801 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
28802 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
28803 .cindex "caching" "callout"
28804 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
28805 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
28806 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
28807 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
28808 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
28809 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
28811 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
28812 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
28815 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
28816 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
28817 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
28819 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
28820 commands up to and including
28824 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
28825 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
28826 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
28827 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
28828 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
28829 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
28830 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
28832 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
28833 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
28834 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
28835 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
28836 will eventually be noticed.
28838 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
28839 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
28840 behaviour will be the same.
28844 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
28845 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
28846 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
28847 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
28848 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
28849 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
28852 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
28854 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
28855 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
28856 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
28857 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
28858 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
28859 550 Sender verification failed
28861 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
28862 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
28863 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
28864 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
28867 verify = sender/no_details
28870 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
28871 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
28872 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
28873 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
28874 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
28875 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
28876 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
28879 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
28880 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
28881 verification also fails.
28883 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
28884 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
28887 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
28888 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
28889 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
28892 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
28894 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
28895 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
28896 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
28897 verification to succeed.
28899 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
28900 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
28901 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
28902 option. For example:
28904 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
28906 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
28907 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
28909 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
28910 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
28911 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
28912 address and a report is output for each of them.
28916 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
28917 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
28918 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
28919 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
28920 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
28921 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
28922 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
28926 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
28927 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
28928 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
28929 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
28930 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
28931 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
28933 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
28934 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
28935 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
28936 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
28939 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
28941 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
28943 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
28944 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
28946 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
28947 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
28950 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
28951 use for the DNS query. The default is:
28953 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
28955 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
28956 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
28957 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
28958 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
28961 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
28963 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
28964 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
28965 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
28967 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
28968 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
28969 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
28970 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
28971 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
28972 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
28973 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
28974 of legitimate HELO domains.
28976 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
28977 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
28978 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
28979 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
28982 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
28984 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
28985 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
28986 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
28991 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
28992 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
28993 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
28994 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
28995 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
28996 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
28997 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
28998 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
29000 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
29001 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
29002 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
29003 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
29004 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
29005 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
29006 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
29008 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
29009 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
29012 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
29013 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
29016 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
29017 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
29020 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
29021 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
29023 recipients = +batv_senders
29025 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
29026 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
29028 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
29029 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
29030 !condition = $prvscheck_result
29032 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
29033 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
29034 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
29035 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
29036 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
29038 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
29039 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
29040 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
29041 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
29042 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
29043 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
29044 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
29046 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
29047 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
29048 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
29049 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
29053 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
29055 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
29056 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
29057 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
29060 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
29063 external_smtp_batv:
29065 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
29066 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
29067 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
29068 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
29071 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
29075 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
29076 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
29077 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
29078 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
29079 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
29080 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
29081 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
29082 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
29083 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
29084 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
29086 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
29087 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
29088 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
29089 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
29090 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
29091 same host is fulfilling both functions,
29093 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
29095 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
29096 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
29097 system to arbitrary domains.
29100 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
29101 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
29102 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
29103 example, suppose you want to do the following:
29106 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
29107 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
29108 &'my.dom2.example'&.
29110 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
29111 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
29113 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
29114 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
29118 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
29120 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
29121 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
29122 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
29124 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
29128 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
29129 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
29131 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
29132 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
29133 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
29134 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
29135 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
29136 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
29137 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
29141 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
29142 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
29143 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
29144 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
29145 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
29147 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
29148 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
29149 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
29150 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
29151 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
29152 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
29153 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
29158 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29159 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29161 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
29162 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
29163 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
29164 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
29165 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
29166 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
29169 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
29170 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
29171 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
29172 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
29173 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
29175 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
29176 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
29177 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
29180 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
29181 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
29183 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
29184 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
29185 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
29187 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
29188 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
29190 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
29193 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
29196 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
29197 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
29198 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
29200 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
29201 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
29202 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
29203 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
29204 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
29205 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
29207 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
29208 temporarily created in a file called:
29210 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
29212 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
29213 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
29214 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
29215 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
29216 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
29218 control = no_mbox_unspool
29220 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
29221 same directory by default.
29225 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
29226 .cindex "virus scanning"
29227 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
29228 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
29229 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
29230 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
29231 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
29232 in memory and thus are much faster.
29235 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
29236 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in first part of the Exim configuration
29237 file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
29238 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
29240 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
29242 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
29244 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
29246 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
29247 before use. The following scanner types are supported in this release:
29250 .vitem &%aveserver%&
29251 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
29252 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
29253 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
29254 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
29257 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
29262 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
29263 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
29264 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
29265 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
29266 in the MIME ACL. This no longer believed to be necessary. One option is
29267 required: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
29268 number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
29270 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
29271 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
29272 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
29274 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the local
29275 keyword, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
29276 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
29277 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
29278 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
29279 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
29280 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
29281 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
29282 contributing the code for this scanner.
29285 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
29286 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
29287 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
29288 type takes 3 mandatory options:
29291 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
29292 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
29295 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
29296 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
29297 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
29298 the &"trigger"& expression.
29301 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
29302 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
29303 &"name"& expression.
29306 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
29308 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
29310 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
29311 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
29312 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
29313 configuration setting:
29315 av_scanner = cmdline:\
29316 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
29317 found in file:'(.+)'
29320 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
29321 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface takes one
29322 argument, either a full path to a UNIX socket, or an IP address and port
29323 separated by white space, as in these examples:
29325 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
29326 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
29328 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
29329 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
29332 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
29333 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
29334 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
29336 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
29338 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
29339 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
29341 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
29342 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
29343 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
29344 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
29345 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
29348 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
29350 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
29353 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
29354 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
29355 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
29356 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
29357 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
29358 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
29359 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
29361 av_scanner = mksd:2
29363 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
29366 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
29367 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
29368 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
29369 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
29370 client communication. For example:
29372 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
29374 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
29378 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
29379 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
29382 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
29383 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
29384 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
29385 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
29386 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
29387 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
29390 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
29391 use. It can then be one of
29394 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
29395 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
29398 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
29399 the condition fails immediately.
29401 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
29402 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
29403 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
29406 You can append &`/defer_ok`& to the &%malware%& condition to accept messages
29407 even if there is a problem with the virus scanner. Otherwise, such a problem
29408 causes the ACL to defer.
29410 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
29411 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
29412 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
29413 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
29416 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
29417 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
29418 &%malware%& condition.
29420 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
29421 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
29423 Here is a very simple scanning example:
29425 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29429 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
29431 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29433 malware = */defer_ok
29435 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
29436 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
29438 av_scanner = $acl_m0
29440 in the main Exim configuration.
29442 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29443 set acl_m0 = sophie
29446 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29447 set acl_m0 = aveserver
29452 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin" "SECTscanspamass"
29453 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
29454 .cindex "spam scanning"
29455 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
29456 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
29457 score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
29458 &url(http://www.spamassassin.org), or, if you have a working Perl
29459 installation, you can use CPAN by running:
29461 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
29463 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
29464 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
29467 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
29468 After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the &%spamd%& daemon.
29469 By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
29470 port for &%spamd%&, you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global
29471 part of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
29473 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
29475 You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
29476 &%spamd%& also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
29477 these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute file name instead of a
29480 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
29482 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
29483 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
29484 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
29485 option, separated with colons:
29487 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
29488 192.168.2.11 783 : \
29491 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported. The servers are queried in a random
29492 fashion. When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
29493 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
29496 &*Warning*&: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
29497 multiple &%spamd%& servers.
29499 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
29500 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
29501 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
29504 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
29505 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
29507 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
29510 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
29511 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
29512 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
29513 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
29514 However, you must put something on the right-hand side.
29516 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
29517 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
29518 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
29519 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA ACL in order to be able to
29520 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
29523 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
29524 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
29525 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
29528 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
29529 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
29530 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
29533 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
29534 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
29538 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
29539 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
29540 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
29541 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
29543 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
29544 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
29545 variables. These variables are saved with the received message, thus they are
29546 available for use at delivery time.
29549 .vitem &$spam_score$&
29550 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
29551 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
29553 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
29554 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
29555 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
29556 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
29557 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
29559 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
29560 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
29561 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
29562 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
29563 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
29565 .vitem &$spam_report$&
29566 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
29567 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
29570 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
29571 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
29572 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
29574 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
29575 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
29576 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
29577 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
29578 spam condition, like this:
29580 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
29581 spam = joe/defer_ok
29583 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
29585 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
29588 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
29589 warn spam = nobody:true
29590 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
29591 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
29593 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
29594 # is over threshold
29596 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
29598 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
29599 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
29601 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
29606 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
29607 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
29608 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
29609 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
29610 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
29611 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
29612 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
29613 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
29614 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
29615 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
29618 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
29619 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
29620 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
29621 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
29622 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
29623 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
29624 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
29626 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
29627 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
29628 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
29629 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
29630 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
29632 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
29633 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
29634 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
29635 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
29636 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
29639 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
29641 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
29645 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
29647 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
29648 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
29649 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
29650 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
29652 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
29653 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
29654 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
29655 the full path and file name.
29657 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
29658 filename, and the default path is then used.
29660 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
29661 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
29662 a file with its original, proposed filename using
29664 decode = $mime_filename
29666 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
29667 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
29668 automatically unlinked.
29670 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
29671 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
29672 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
29673 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
29674 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
29676 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
29677 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
29678 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
29680 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
29681 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
29682 available in the MIME ACL:
29685 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
29686 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
29687 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
29688 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
29689 contains the empty string.
29691 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
29692 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
29693 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
29699 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
29700 case-insensitively.
29702 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
29703 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
29704 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
29705 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
29706 only used for display purposes.
29708 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
29709 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
29710 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
29712 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
29713 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
29714 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
29716 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
29717 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
29718 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
29719 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
29720 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
29722 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
29723 This variable contains the normalized content of the
29724 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
29725 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
29727 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
29728 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
29729 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
29730 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
29734 application/octet-stream
29738 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
29741 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
29742 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
29743 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
29744 containing the decoded data.
29749 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
29750 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
29751 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
29752 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
29753 RFC2047 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was
29754 found, this variable contains the empty string.
29756 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
29757 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
29758 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
29759 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
29761 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
29762 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
29766 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
29769 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
29770 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
29773 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
29774 and the rest are attachments.
29777 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
29780 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
29781 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
29782 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
29784 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
29785 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
29786 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
29787 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
29789 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
29790 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
29791 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
29792 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
29793 want to carry out specific actions on them.
29795 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
29796 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
29797 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
29798 decoding is fully recursive.
29800 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
29801 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
29802 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
29803 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
29804 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
29805 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
29806 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
29811 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
29812 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
29813 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
29814 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
29815 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
29817 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
29818 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
29819 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
29820 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
29821 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
29823 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
29824 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
29825 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
29826 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
29827 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
29828 32K characters are checked.
29830 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
29831 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
29832 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
29833 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
29834 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
29836 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
29837 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
29839 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
29840 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
29841 matching regular expression.
29843 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
29849 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
29850 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
29851 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
29852 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
29853 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
29854 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
29855 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
29856 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
29857 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
29858 use the &%demime%& condition.
29860 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
29861 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
29862 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
29863 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
29864 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
29865 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
29867 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
29868 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
29871 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
29872 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
29874 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
29875 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
29876 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
29877 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
29879 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
29880 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
29881 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
29883 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
29886 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
29887 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
29888 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
29889 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
29890 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
29891 zero, no error occurred.
29893 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
29894 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
29895 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
29896 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
29900 .vitem &$found_extension$&
29901 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
29902 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
29903 extension it found.
29906 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
29907 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
29909 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
29910 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
29911 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
29914 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
29915 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
29917 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
29919 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
29920 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
29921 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
29922 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
29924 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
29925 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
29926 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
29935 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29936 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29938 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
29939 "Local scan function"
29940 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
29941 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
29942 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
29943 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
29944 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
29946 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
29947 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
29948 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
29949 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
29950 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
29952 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
29953 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
29954 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
29955 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
29957 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
29958 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
29959 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
29960 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
29962 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
29963 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
29964 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
29965 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
29966 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
29967 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
29968 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
29969 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
29970 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
29974 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
29975 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
29976 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
29977 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
29978 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
29979 directory, so you might set
29981 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
29983 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
29984 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
29985 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
29986 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
29987 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
29988 _src/local_scan.c_.
29990 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
29991 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
29993 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
29995 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
30000 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
30001 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
30002 You must include this line near the start of your code:
30004 #include "local_scan.h"
30006 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
30007 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
30008 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
30009 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
30010 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
30011 strings and pointers to character strings:
30013 #define CS (char *)
30014 #define CCS (const char *)
30015 #define CSS (char **)
30016 #define US (unsigned char *)
30017 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
30018 #define USS (unsigned char **)
30020 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
30022 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
30024 The arguments are as follows:
30027 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
30028 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
30029 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
30031 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
30032 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
30033 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
30034 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
30035 case this changes in some future version.
30037 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
30038 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
30041 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
30044 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
30045 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
30046 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
30047 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
30048 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
30049 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
30051 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
30052 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
30053 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
30055 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
30056 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
30057 queued without immediate delivery.
30059 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
30060 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
30061 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
30062 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
30063 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
30066 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
30067 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
30068 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
30071 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
30072 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
30073 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
30074 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
30075 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
30076 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
30077 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
30079 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
30080 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
30081 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
30084 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
30085 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
30086 &%-oe%& command line options.
30090 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
30091 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
30092 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
30093 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
30094 want to do this, you must have the line
30096 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
30098 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
30099 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
30100 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
30103 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
30104 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
30105 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
30106 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
30107 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
30108 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
30110 static int my_integer_option = 42;
30111 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
30113 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
30114 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
30115 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
30118 int local_scan_options_count =
30119 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
30121 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
30122 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
30126 my_string = some string of text...
30128 The available types of option data are as follows:
30131 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
30132 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
30133 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
30134 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
30135 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
30136 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
30139 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
30140 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
30141 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
30142 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
30145 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
30146 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
30149 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
30150 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
30151 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
30152 printed with the suffix K or M.
30154 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
30155 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
30156 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
30157 always output in octal.
30159 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
30160 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
30161 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
30163 .vitem &*opt_time*&
30164 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
30165 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
30168 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
30169 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
30173 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
30174 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
30175 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
30176 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
30177 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
30178 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
30179 C variables are as follows:
30182 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
30183 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
30185 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
30186 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
30188 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
30189 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
30190 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
30191 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
30194 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
30195 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
30196 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
30199 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
30200 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
30204 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
30205 selected, you should use code like this:
30207 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
30208 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
30210 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
30211 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
30212 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
30214 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
30215 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
30218 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
30219 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
30221 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
30222 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
30224 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
30225 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
30226 &%-bh%& command line option.
30228 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
30229 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
30230 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
30232 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
30233 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
30234 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
30235 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
30237 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
30238 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
30239 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
30241 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
30242 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
30244 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
30245 The number of accepted recipients.
30247 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
30248 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
30249 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
30250 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
30251 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
30252 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
30253 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
30254 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
30255 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
30256 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
30257 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
30258 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
30260 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
30261 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
30263 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
30264 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
30265 locally-submitted messages.
30267 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
30268 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
30269 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
30271 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
30272 The name of the sending host, if known.
30274 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
30275 The port on the sending host.
30277 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
30278 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
30280 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
30281 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
30283 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
30284 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
30285 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
30289 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
30290 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
30291 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
30292 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
30297 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
30298 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
30300 .vitem &*int&~type*&
30301 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
30302 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
30303 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
30304 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
30305 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
30306 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
30308 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
30309 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
30312 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
30313 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
30314 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
30319 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
30320 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
30323 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
30324 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
30326 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
30327 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
30328 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
30329 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
30331 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
30332 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
30333 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
30334 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
30335 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
30336 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
30337 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
30338 is NULL for all recipients.
30343 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
30344 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
30345 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
30346 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
30350 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
30351 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
30353 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
30354 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
30355 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
30356 for the process in &%newumask%&.
30358 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
30359 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
30360 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
30361 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
30362 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
30364 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
30366 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
30367 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
30368 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
30369 return value is as follows:
30374 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
30380 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
30386 The process timed out.
30390 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
30393 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
30394 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
30395 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
30396 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
30397 forks a subprocess that is running
30399 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
30401 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
30402 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
30403 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
30404 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
30406 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
30407 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
30408 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
30409 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
30412 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
30413 *sender_authentication)*&
30414 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
30417 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
30419 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
30422 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
30423 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
30424 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
30425 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
30426 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
30428 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
30429 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
30432 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
30433 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
30434 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
30435 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
30436 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
30437 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
30438 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
30439 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
30441 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
30442 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
30443 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
30444 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
30445 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
30446 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
30448 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
30449 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
30450 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
30451 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
30453 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
30454 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
30455 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
30456 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
30457 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
30458 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
30459 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
30460 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
30461 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
30462 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
30464 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
30465 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
30467 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
30468 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
30471 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
30472 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
30473 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
30474 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
30475 match the specification, the function does nothing.
30478 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
30479 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
30480 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
30481 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
30482 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
30483 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
30485 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
30487 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
30488 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
30489 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
30490 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
30491 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
30494 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
30495 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
30496 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
30497 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
30498 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
30499 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
30500 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
30501 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
30503 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
30504 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
30505 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
30507 &`OK `& match succeeded
30508 &`FAIL `& match failed
30509 &`DEFER `& match deferred
30511 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
30512 inability to contact a database.
30514 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
30516 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
30517 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
30518 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
30520 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
30522 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
30523 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
30524 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
30526 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
30528 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
30531 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
30533 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
30534 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
30535 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
30536 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
30537 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
30538 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
30541 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
30543 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
30544 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
30545 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
30546 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
30547 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
30548 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
30551 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
30552 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
30553 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
30554 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
30556 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
30557 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
30558 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
30559 value afterwards. For example:
30561 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
30562 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
30563 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
30566 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
30567 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
30568 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
30569 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
30576 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
30577 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
30578 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
30579 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
30580 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
30581 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
30582 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
30583 binary string is returned with an error message.
30585 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
30586 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
30587 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
30589 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
30590 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
30591 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
30592 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
30593 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
30595 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
30596 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
30597 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
30599 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
30600 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
30601 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
30602 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
30606 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
30607 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
30610 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
30611 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
30612 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
30613 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
30614 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
30615 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
30616 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
30617 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
30620 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
30621 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
30623 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
30624 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
30625 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
30626 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
30627 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
30628 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
30629 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
30631 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
30632 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
30634 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
30635 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
30636 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
30637 multiple output lines.
30639 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
30640 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
30641 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
30642 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
30643 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
30644 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
30645 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
30648 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
30649 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
30650 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
30651 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
30653 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
30654 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
30655 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
30657 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
30660 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
30663 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
30664 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
30665 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
30666 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
30667 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
30668 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
30674 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
30675 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
30676 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
30677 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
30678 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
30679 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
30680 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
30683 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
30684 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
30685 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
30686 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
30688 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
30689 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
30691 store_pool = POOL_PERM
30693 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
30694 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
30695 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
30696 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
30698 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
30699 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
30700 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
30701 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
30708 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30709 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30711 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
30712 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
30713 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
30714 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
30715 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
30716 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
30717 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
30718 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
30720 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
30721 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
30722 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
30723 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
30724 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
30726 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
30727 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
30728 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
30729 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
30730 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
30731 prevent it happening on retries.
30733 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30734 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
30735 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
30736 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
30737 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
30738 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
30739 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
30740 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
30743 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
30744 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
30745 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
30746 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
30747 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
30748 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
30749 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
30751 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
30752 system_filter_user = exim
30754 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
30755 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
30756 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
30757 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
30758 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
30759 by the &%reply%& command.
30762 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
30763 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
30764 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
30765 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
30767 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
30768 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
30772 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
30773 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
30774 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
30775 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
30776 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
30777 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
30780 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
30781 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
30782 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
30783 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
30784 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
30785 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
30786 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
30788 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
30789 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
30790 succeed, it will not be tried again.
30791 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
30792 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
30794 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
30795 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
30796 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
30797 to which users' filter files can refer.
30801 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
30802 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
30803 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
30804 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
30805 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
30809 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
30810 .cindex "freezing messages"
30811 .cindex "message" "freezing"
30812 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
30813 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
30814 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
30815 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
30816 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
30817 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
30818 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
30819 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
30820 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
30822 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
30824 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
30826 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
30827 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
30828 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
30829 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
30830 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
30833 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
30834 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
30835 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
30836 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
30838 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
30839 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
30840 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
30841 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
30842 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
30843 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
30844 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
30845 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
30846 message. For example:
30848 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
30849 because it contains attachments that we are \
30850 not prepared to receive."
30853 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
30854 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
30855 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
30856 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
30857 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
30858 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
30861 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
30862 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
30864 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
30865 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
30866 generated by the filter.
30868 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
30870 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
30871 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
30877 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
30878 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
30883 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
30884 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
30885 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
30886 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
30887 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
30889 headers add <string>
30890 headers remove <string>
30892 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
30893 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
30894 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
30895 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
30896 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
30898 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
30899 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
30900 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
30903 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
30904 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
30907 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
30908 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
30909 space after input continuations is ignored.
30911 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
30912 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
30913 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
30914 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
30915 header with the same name, they are all removed.
30917 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
30918 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
30919 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
30920 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
30921 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
30922 used for all recipients of the message.
30924 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
30925 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
30926 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
30927 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
30928 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
30929 until the message is actually being written (see section
30930 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
30932 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
30933 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
30934 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
30935 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
30936 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
30937 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
30938 modified more than once.
30940 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
30941 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
30944 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
30945 headers remove "Subject"
30946 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
30947 headers remove "Old-Subject"
30952 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
30953 .cindex "envelope sender"
30954 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
30956 errors_to <some address>
30958 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
30959 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
30960 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
30963 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
30965 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
30966 address if its delivery failed.
30970 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
30971 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30972 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
30973 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
30974 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
30975 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
30976 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
30977 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
30978 which implements such a filter:
30983 domains = +local_domains
30984 file = /central/filters/$local_part
30989 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
30990 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
30991 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
30992 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
30994 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
30995 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
30996 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
30997 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
30999 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
31000 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
31001 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
31008 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31009 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31011 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
31012 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
31013 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
31014 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
31015 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
31016 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
31017 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
31018 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
31020 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
31021 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
31022 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
31023 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
31024 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
31026 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
31027 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
31028 loopback interface specially in any way.
31030 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
31031 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
31036 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
31037 .cindex "message" "submission"
31038 .cindex "submission mode"
31039 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
31040 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
31041 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
31042 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
31044 control = submission
31046 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
31047 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
31048 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
31049 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
31050 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
31051 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
31053 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
31054 control = submission
31056 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
31057 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
31058 is used to separate options. For example:
31060 control = submission/sender_retain
31062 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
31063 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
31064 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
31065 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
31066 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
31067 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
31068 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
31070 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
31071 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
31074 control = submission/domain=some.domain
31076 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
31077 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
31078 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
31079 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
31081 accept authenticated = *
31082 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
31083 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
31084 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
31086 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
31087 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
31088 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
31090 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
31092 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
31095 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
31097 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
31098 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
31099 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
31100 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
31102 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
31103 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
31104 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
31105 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
31106 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
31107 spoof another's address.
31109 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
31110 .cindex "line endings"
31111 .cindex "carriage return"
31113 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
31114 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
31115 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
31116 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
31117 use CRLF or just CR.
31119 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
31120 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
31121 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
31122 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
31123 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
31124 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
31125 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
31126 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
31130 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
31132 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
31135 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
31136 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
31139 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
31140 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
31141 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
31142 people trying to play silly games.
31144 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
31145 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
31153 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
31154 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
31155 .cindex "address" "qualification"
31156 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
31157 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
31158 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
31159 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
31160 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
31162 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
31163 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
31164 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
31165 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
31166 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
31168 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
31169 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
31170 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
31171 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
31172 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
31173 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
31174 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
31175 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
31180 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
31181 .cindex "&""From""& line"
31182 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
31183 .cindex "sender" "address"
31184 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
31185 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
31186 .cindex "envelope sender"
31187 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
31188 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
31189 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
31190 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
31192 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
31193 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
31195 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
31196 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
31197 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
31198 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
31199 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
31200 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
31201 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
31202 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
31203 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
31205 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
31206 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
31207 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
31208 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
31209 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
31210 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
31211 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
31213 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
31214 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
31215 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
31217 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
31218 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
31219 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
31220 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
31224 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
31225 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
31226 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
31227 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
31228 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
31229 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
31230 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
31233 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
31234 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
31237 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
31238 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
31242 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
31243 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
31245 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
31246 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
31247 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
31249 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
31252 For a locally-submitted message,
31253 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
31254 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
31255 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
31256 included in log lines in this case.
31258 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
31259 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
31265 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
31266 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
31267 includes the header line:
31269 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
31272 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
31273 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
31274 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
31275 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
31276 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
31277 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
31280 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
31281 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
31282 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
31283 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
31284 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
31286 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
31287 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
31288 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
31289 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
31290 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
31291 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
31292 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
31293 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
31297 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
31298 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
31299 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
31300 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
31301 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
31302 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
31303 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
31304 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
31308 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
31309 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
31310 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
31311 .cindex "message" "submission"
31312 .cindex "submission mode"
31313 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
31314 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
31317 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
31318 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
31320 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
31321 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
31323 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31324 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
31325 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
31327 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
31328 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
31330 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
31331 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
31335 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
31337 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
31338 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
31339 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
31340 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
31341 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
31342 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
31343 &%qualify_domain%&.
31345 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
31346 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
31347 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
31348 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
31351 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
31352 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
31353 .cindex "message" "submission"
31354 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
31355 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
31356 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
31357 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
31358 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
31359 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
31360 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
31361 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
31362 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
31363 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
31366 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
31367 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
31368 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
31369 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
31370 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
31372 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
31373 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
31374 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
31375 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
31377 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
31378 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
31379 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
31382 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
31383 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
31384 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
31385 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
31386 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
31387 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
31388 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
31389 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
31390 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
31391 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
31392 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
31396 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
31397 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
31398 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
31399 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
31400 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
31401 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
31402 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
31403 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
31407 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
31408 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
31409 .cindex "message" "submission"
31410 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
31411 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
31412 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
31413 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
31416 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
31417 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
31418 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
31419 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
31420 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
31421 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
31422 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
31423 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
31424 line is added to the message.
31426 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
31427 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
31428 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
31429 options true at the same time.
31431 .cindex "submission mode"
31432 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
31433 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
31434 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
31435 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
31437 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
31438 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
31439 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
31440 created as follows:
31443 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31444 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
31445 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
31447 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
31448 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
31450 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
31451 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
31454 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
31455 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
31456 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
31457 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
31459 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
31460 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
31461 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
31462 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
31466 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
31467 "SECTheadersaddrem"
31468 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
31469 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
31470 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
31471 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
31472 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
31473 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
31474 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
31476 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
31477 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
31478 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
31479 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
31480 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
31481 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
31483 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
31484 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
31485 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
31487 For both routers and transports, the result of expanding a &%headers_add%&
31488 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
31489 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
31491 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
31492 X-added-second: another added header line
31494 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
31496 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
31497 specified; the values will be concatenated (with a separating newline
31498 added) before expansion.
31500 The result of expanding &%headers_remove%& must consist of a colon-separated
31501 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
31502 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
31503 not part of the names. For example:
31505 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
31508 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
31509 specified; the values will be concatenated (with a separating colon
31510 added) before expansion.
31512 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router, its value
31513 is expanded at routing time, and then associated with all addresses that are
31514 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
31515 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
31516 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
31518 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
31519 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
31520 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
31521 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
31523 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
31524 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
31525 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
31528 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
31529 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
31530 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
31531 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
31532 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
31533 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
31534 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
31536 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
31537 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
31538 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
31539 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
31541 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
31542 the following consequences:
31545 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
31546 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
31547 to it, at all times.
31549 Header lines that are added by a router's
31550 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
31551 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
31553 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
31554 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
31556 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
31557 a later router or by a transport.
31559 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
31560 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
31562 headers_remove = subject
31563 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
31567 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
31568 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
31574 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
31575 .cindex "address" "constructed"
31576 .cindex "constructed address"
31577 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
31580 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
31584 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
31586 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
31587 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
31588 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
31589 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
31590 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
31591 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
31592 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
31593 there is no password file entry.
31596 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
31597 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
31598 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
31599 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
31600 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
31601 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
31602 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
31603 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
31607 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
31608 .cindex "case of local parts"
31609 .cindex "local part" "case of"
31610 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
31611 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
31612 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
31613 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
31614 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
31615 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
31618 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
31619 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
31620 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
31621 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
31622 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
31626 domains = +local_domains
31627 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
31628 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
31631 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
31632 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
31633 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
31634 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
31635 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
31639 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
31640 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
31641 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
31642 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
31643 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
31644 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
31645 empty components for compatibility.
31649 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
31650 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
31651 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
31652 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
31653 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
31654 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
31656 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
31657 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
31658 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
31659 example, a header such as
31663 might get rewritten as
31665 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
31667 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
31668 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
31671 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
31672 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
31673 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
31674 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
31675 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
31676 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
31677 .ecindex IIDmesproc
31681 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31682 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31684 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
31685 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
31686 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
31687 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
31688 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
31689 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
31690 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
31693 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
31695 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
31697 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
31700 For mail delivery, the following are available:
31703 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
31705 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
31708 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
31711 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
31712 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
31715 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
31716 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
31717 used to contain the envelope information.
31721 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
31722 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
31723 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
31724 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
31725 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
31728 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
31729 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
31730 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
31731 processing is the same in both cases.
31733 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
31734 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
31735 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
31736 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
31737 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
31738 .cindex "transport" "filter"
31739 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
31740 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
31743 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
31744 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
31745 required for the transaction.
31747 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
31748 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
31749 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
31750 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
31751 is called for verification.
31753 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
31754 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
31755 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
31757 .cindex "carriage return"
31759 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
31760 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
31761 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
31764 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
31765 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
31766 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
31767 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
31768 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
31769 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
31770 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
31771 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
31772 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
31774 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
31775 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
31776 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
31777 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
31779 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
31780 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
31781 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
31782 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
31784 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
31785 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
31786 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
31787 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
31788 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
31789 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
31790 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
31791 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
31792 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
31793 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
31795 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
31796 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
31798 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
31799 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
31800 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
31801 square bracket of the IP address.
31806 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
31807 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
31808 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
31809 .cindex "host" "error"
31810 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
31811 message errors, and recipient errors.
31814 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
31815 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
31816 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
31819 Connection refused or timed out,
31821 Any error response code on connection,
31823 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
31825 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
31827 I/O errors at any time,
31829 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
31830 the &"."& at the end of the data.
31833 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
31834 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
31835 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
31836 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
31837 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
31838 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
31839 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
31840 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
31842 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
31843 .cindex "message" "error"
31844 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
31845 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
31846 message errors are:
31849 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
31852 Timeout after MAIL,
31854 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
31855 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
31856 connection at any other time.
31859 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
31860 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
31861 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
31862 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
31863 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
31864 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
31865 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
31866 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
31867 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
31868 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
31870 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
31871 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
31872 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
31875 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
31876 .cindex "recipient" "error"
31877 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
31878 recipient errors are:
31881 Any error response to RCPT,
31883 Timeout after RCPT.
31886 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
31887 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
31888 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
31889 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
31890 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
31891 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
31892 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
31893 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
31894 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
31895 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
31896 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
31897 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
31898 the retry clock is reset.
31900 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
31901 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
31902 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
31903 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
31904 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
31905 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
31906 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
31907 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
31908 recipient's retry time.
31911 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
31912 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
31913 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
31914 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
31915 until the next delivery attempt.
31917 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
31918 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
31919 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
31920 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
31921 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
31924 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
31925 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
31926 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
31927 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
31928 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
31929 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
31930 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
31932 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
31933 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
31934 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
31935 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
31936 then to be treated as a host error.
31938 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
31939 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
31940 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
31941 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
31942 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
31947 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
31948 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
31949 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
31952 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
31953 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
31954 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
31956 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
31958 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
31959 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
31960 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
31961 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
31962 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
31963 stream and exits with an error code.
31965 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
31966 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
31967 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
31968 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
31970 .cindex "carriage return"
31972 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
31973 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
31974 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
31976 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
31977 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
31978 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
31980 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
31981 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
31982 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
31983 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
31984 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
31985 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
31986 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
31987 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
31989 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
31990 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
31991 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
31992 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
31993 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
31994 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
31995 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
31996 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
31997 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
31999 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
32000 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
32001 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
32003 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
32004 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
32005 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
32006 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
32007 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
32009 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
32010 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
32011 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
32012 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
32013 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
32014 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
32015 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
32017 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
32018 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
32019 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
32020 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
32021 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
32023 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
32024 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
32025 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
32026 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
32027 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
32028 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
32029 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
32030 a delivery process.
32032 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
32033 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
32034 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
32035 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
32036 however, available with &'inetd'&.
32038 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
32039 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
32040 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
32041 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
32043 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
32044 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
32045 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
32049 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
32050 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
32051 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
32052 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
32053 the error response to the last command. The default value for
32054 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
32055 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
32056 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
32059 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
32060 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
32061 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
32062 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
32063 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
32064 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
32065 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
32066 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
32067 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
32068 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
32069 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
32073 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
32074 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
32075 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
32076 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
32077 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
32078 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
32079 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
32080 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
32082 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
32083 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
32084 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
32085 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
32086 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
32089 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
32090 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
32091 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
32093 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
32094 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
32095 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
32096 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
32097 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
32102 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
32103 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
32104 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
32105 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
32106 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
32108 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
32109 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
32110 called with the &%-bv%& option.
32112 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
32113 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
32114 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
32115 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
32116 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
32117 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
32118 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
32123 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
32124 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
32125 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
32126 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
32127 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
32128 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
32129 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
32131 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
32132 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
32133 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
32134 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
32135 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
32136 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
32137 argument. For example,
32145 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
32146 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
32147 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
32148 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
32149 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
32151 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
32152 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
32153 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
32154 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
32155 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
32156 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
32157 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
32158 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
32160 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
32161 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
32162 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
32163 whatever the form of its argument. For
32166 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
32167 $sender_host_address
32169 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32170 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
32171 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
32172 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
32173 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
32174 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
32175 for it to change them before running the command.
32179 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
32180 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
32181 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
32182 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
32183 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
32184 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
32185 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
32186 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
32187 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
32188 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
32189 runs for RCPT commands:
32193 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
32197 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
32198 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
32199 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
32200 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
32201 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
32202 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
32203 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
32204 envelope along with the message.
32206 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
32207 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
32208 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
32209 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
32210 can be used to specify it.
32212 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
32213 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
32214 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
32215 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
32216 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
32219 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
32220 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
32221 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
32226 driver = manualroute
32227 transport = smtp_appendfile
32228 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
32232 driver = appendfile
32233 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
32238 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
32239 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
32240 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
32244 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
32245 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
32246 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
32247 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
32248 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
32249 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
32250 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
32251 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
32252 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
32253 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
32255 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
32256 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
32258 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
32259 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
32260 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
32261 make some use of automatically, for example:
32263 554 Unexpected end of file
32264 Transaction started in line 10
32265 Error detected in line 14
32267 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
32270 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
32271 The error message was:
32273 501 '>' missing at end of address
32275 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
32276 The error was detected in line 12.
32277 The SMTP command at fault was:
32279 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
32281 1 previous message was successfully processed.
32282 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
32284 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
32285 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
32287 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
32288 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
32292 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32293 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32295 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
32296 "Customizing messages"
32297 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
32298 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
32299 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
32300 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
32301 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
32303 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
32304 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
32305 option. Exim also adds the line
32307 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
32309 to all warning and bounce messages,
32312 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
32313 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
32314 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
32315 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
32316 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
32317 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
32318 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
32320 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
32321 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
32322 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
32323 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
32324 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
32327 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
32328 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
32329 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
32330 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
32331 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
32332 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
32333 option, rounded to a whole number.
32335 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
32338 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
32339 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
32341 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
32342 failing addresses with their error messages.
32344 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
32345 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
32347 The fourth item is used to introduce the copy of the message that is returned
32348 as part of the error report.
32350 The fifth item is added after the fourth one if the returned message is
32351 truncated because it is bigger than &%return_size_limit%&.
32353 The sixth item is added after the copy of the original message.
32356 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
32357 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
32358 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
32360 Subject: Mail delivery failed
32361 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
32362 {: returning message to sender}}
32364 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
32366 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
32367 {that you sent }{sent by
32371 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
32372 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
32374 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
32376 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
32379 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
32381 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
32384 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
32385 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
32386 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
32387 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
32388 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
32392 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
32393 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
32395 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
32396 the delayed addresses.
32398 The third item then ends the message.
32401 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
32402 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
32404 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
32405 $warn_message_delay
32407 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
32409 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
32410 {that you sent }{sent by
32414 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
32415 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
32417 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
32418 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
32419 The date of the message is: $h_date
32421 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
32423 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
32424 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
32425 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
32426 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
32427 the message will be returned to you.
32429 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
32430 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
32431 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
32432 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
32433 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
32434 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
32435 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
32436 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
32442 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32443 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32445 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
32446 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
32447 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
32451 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
32452 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
32453 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
32454 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
32455 routing explicitly:
32457 send_to_smart_host:
32458 driver = manualroute
32459 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
32460 transport = remote_smtp
32462 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
32463 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
32464 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
32465 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
32466 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
32471 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
32472 .cindex "mailing lists"
32473 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
32474 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
32475 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
32477 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
32478 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
32479 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
32480 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
32484 domains = lists.example
32485 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
32488 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
32491 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
32492 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
32493 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
32494 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
32496 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
32497 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
32500 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
32501 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
32502 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
32503 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
32504 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
32506 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
32507 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
32508 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
32509 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
32510 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
32511 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
32512 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
32513 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
32514 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
32518 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
32519 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
32520 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
32521 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
32522 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
32523 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
32524 addresses are not rigorously checked.
32526 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
32527 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
32528 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
32529 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
32530 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
32534 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
32535 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
32536 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
32537 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
32538 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
32539 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
32540 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
32541 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
32542 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
32543 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
32545 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
32546 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
32547 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
32548 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
32549 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
32550 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
32551 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
32552 pre-existing messages.
32554 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
32555 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
32556 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
32557 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
32558 one level of expansion anyway.
32562 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
32563 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
32564 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
32565 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
32566 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
32567 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
32569 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
32570 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
32574 domains = lists.example
32575 local_part_suffix = -request
32576 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
32581 domains = lists.example
32582 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
32583 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
32584 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
32587 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
32592 domains = lists.example
32594 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
32596 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
32597 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
32598 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
32601 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
32602 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
32603 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
32604 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
32605 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
32606 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
32607 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
32608 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
32609 &"unrouteable address"& error.
32611 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
32612 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
32613 the address, giving a suitable error message.
32618 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
32620 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
32621 .cindex "envelope sender"
32622 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
32623 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
32624 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
32625 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
32626 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
32627 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
32629 .oindex &%errors_to%&
32630 .oindex &%return_path%&
32631 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
32632 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
32633 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
32634 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
32635 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
32636 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
32637 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
32643 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
32644 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
32646 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
32647 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
32648 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
32649 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
32650 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
32651 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
32652 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
32655 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
32657 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32658 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
32659 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
32660 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
32661 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
32662 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
32664 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
32665 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
32666 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
32667 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
32671 domains = ! +local_domains
32673 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
32674 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
32677 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
32678 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
32679 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
32680 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
32683 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
32684 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
32685 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
32686 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
32687 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
32691 domains = ! +local_domains
32692 transport = remote_smtp
32694 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
32695 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
32698 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
32699 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
32700 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
32701 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
32704 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
32705 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
32706 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
32707 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
32708 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
32709 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
32717 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
32718 .cindex "virtual domains"
32719 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
32720 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
32724 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
32725 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
32726 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
32728 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
32729 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
32730 have login accounts on that host.
32733 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
32734 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
32735 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
32736 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
32737 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
32738 to a router of this form:
32742 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
32743 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
32746 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
32747 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
32748 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
32749 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
32750 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
32751 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
32753 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
32754 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
32755 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
32756 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
32758 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
32759 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
32760 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
32764 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
32765 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
32766 transport = my_mailboxes
32768 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
32769 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
32770 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
32771 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
32772 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
32776 driver = appendfile
32777 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
32780 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
32781 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
32783 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
32784 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
32785 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
32786 information about the domains.
32790 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
32791 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
32792 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
32793 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
32794 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
32795 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
32796 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
32797 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
32798 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
32799 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
32800 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
32801 example, consider this router:
32806 file = $home/.forward
32807 local_part_suffix = -*
32808 local_part_suffix_optional
32811 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
32812 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
32813 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
32814 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
32816 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
32817 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
32820 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
32821 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
32822 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
32823 control over which suffixes are valid.
32825 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
32826 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
32832 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
32833 local_part_suffix = -*
32834 local_part_suffix_optional
32837 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
32838 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
32839 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
32840 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
32841 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
32845 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
32846 .cindex "vacation processing"
32847 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
32848 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
32849 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
32850 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
32851 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
32854 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
32855 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
32856 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
32857 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
32859 spqr, vacation-spqr
32862 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
32863 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
32864 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
32865 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
32866 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
32870 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
32871 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
32875 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
32876 .cindex "message" "copying every"
32877 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
32878 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
32879 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
32880 each day's messages.
32882 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
32883 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
32884 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
32885 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
32889 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
32890 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
32891 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
32892 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
32893 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
32894 permanently connected.
32896 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
32897 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
32898 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
32901 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
32902 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
32903 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
32904 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
32905 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
32906 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
32907 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
32908 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
32910 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
32911 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
32912 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
32913 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
32914 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
32915 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
32918 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
32919 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
32920 intermittent host. For example:
32922 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
32924 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
32925 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
32926 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
32927 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
32928 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
32929 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
32932 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
32933 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
32934 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
32935 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
32936 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
32937 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
32938 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
32942 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
32943 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
32944 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
32945 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
32946 delivered immediately.
32948 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
32949 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
32950 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
32951 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
32952 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
32953 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
32954 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
32955 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
32956 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
32957 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
32958 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
32959 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
32960 single SMTP connection.
32964 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32965 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32967 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
32968 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
32969 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
32970 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
32971 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
32972 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
32973 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
32974 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
32975 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
32976 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
32979 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
32980 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
32981 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
32982 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
32983 email is not desirable.
32985 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
32986 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
32987 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
32988 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
32989 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
32990 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
32991 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
32993 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
32994 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
32995 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
32996 before sending a message to the smart host.
32998 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
32999 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
33000 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
33002 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
33003 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
33004 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
33005 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
33006 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
33007 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
33008 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
33010 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
33014 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
33015 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
33017 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
33018 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
33019 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
33020 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
33021 successful, a zero return code is given.
33023 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
33024 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
33025 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
33026 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
33027 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
33030 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
33031 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
33032 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
33034 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
33035 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
33036 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
33037 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
33038 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
33040 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
33041 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
33042 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
33044 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
33045 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
33046 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
33047 are ever generated.
33049 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
33051 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
33052 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
33053 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
33056 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
33057 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
33058 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
33059 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
33060 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
33061 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
33066 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33067 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33069 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
33070 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
33071 .cindex "log" "types of"
33072 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
33077 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
33078 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
33079 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
33080 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
33081 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
33082 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
33083 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
33084 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
33086 .cindex "reject log"
33087 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
33088 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
33089 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
33090 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
33091 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
33092 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
33093 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
33094 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
33095 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
33098 .cindex "panic log"
33099 .cindex "system log"
33100 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
33101 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
33102 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
33103 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
33104 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
33105 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
33106 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
33107 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
33108 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
33111 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
33112 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
33113 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
33115 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
33118 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
33119 ways of changing this:
33122 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
33127 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
33129 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
33132 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
33136 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
33137 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
33138 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
33139 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
33140 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
33141 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
33146 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
33147 .cindex "log" "destination"
33148 .cindex "log" "to file"
33149 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
33151 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
33152 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
33153 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
33154 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
33155 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
33156 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
33157 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
33159 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
33160 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
33161 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
33162 references to the host name:
33164 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
33166 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
33167 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
33168 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
33169 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
33170 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
33173 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
33174 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
33175 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
33176 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
33177 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
33178 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
33179 implying the use of a default path.
33181 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
33182 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
33183 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
33184 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
33185 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
33186 equivalent to the setting:
33188 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
33190 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
33193 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
33194 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
33196 Here are some examples of possible settings:
33198 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
33199 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
33200 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
33201 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
33203 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
33208 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
33209 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
33210 .cindex "cycling logs"
33211 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
33212 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
33213 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
33214 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
33215 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
33216 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
33217 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
33219 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
33220 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
33221 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
33222 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
33223 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
33224 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
33225 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
33226 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
33227 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
33228 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
33229 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
33234 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
33235 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
33236 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
33237 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
33238 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
33239 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
33240 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
33241 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
33243 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
33244 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
33245 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
33246 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
33248 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
33249 examples of names generated by the above examples:
33251 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
33252 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
33253 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
33254 /var/log/exim/main.200212
33256 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
33257 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
33258 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
33259 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
33261 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
33262 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
33263 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
33264 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
33265 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
33266 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
33269 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
33270 /var/log/exim-panic.log
33271 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
33272 /var/log/exim/panic
33276 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
33277 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
33278 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
33279 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
33280 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
33281 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
33282 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
33283 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
33284 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
33285 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
33286 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
33287 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
33288 the time and host name to each line.
33289 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
33292 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
33294 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
33296 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
33299 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
33300 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
33301 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
33302 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
33304 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
33305 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
33306 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
33307 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
33308 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
33309 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
33310 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
33311 RFC 3164, you should set
33313 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
33315 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
33316 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
33318 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
33319 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
33320 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
33321 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
33322 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
33323 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
33324 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
33325 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
33326 name, and pid as added by syslog:
33328 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
33329 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
33330 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
33331 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
33334 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
33337 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
33338 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
33339 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
33340 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
33342 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
33343 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
33344 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
33345 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
33346 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
33347 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
33349 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
33350 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
33351 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
33354 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
33356 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
33357 without modification.
33359 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
33360 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
33361 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
33366 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
33367 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
33368 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
33369 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
33370 timestamp. The flags are:
33372 &`<=`& message arrival
33373 &`=>`& normal message delivery
33374 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
33375 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
33376 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
33377 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
33381 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
33382 .cindex "log" "reception line"
33383 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
33384 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
33385 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
33387 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
33388 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
33389 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
33391 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
33392 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
33393 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
33397 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
33401 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
33402 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
33403 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
33404 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
33405 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
33406 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
33407 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
33408 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
33409 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
33410 name in parentheses.
33412 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
33413 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
33414 the log containing text like these examples:
33416 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
33417 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
33419 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
33422 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
33423 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
33426 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
33427 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
33428 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
33429 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
33430 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
33431 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
33432 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
33433 suite that was used.
33435 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
33436 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
33437 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
33438 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
33439 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
33440 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
33441 authenticator name.
33443 .cindex "size" "of message"
33444 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
33445 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
33446 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
33447 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
33450 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
33451 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
33455 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
33456 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
33457 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
33458 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
33459 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
33460 to fit it on the page:
33462 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
33463 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
33464 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
33465 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
33466 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
33468 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
33469 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
33470 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
33471 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
33472 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
33474 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
33475 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
33477 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
33479 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
33480 parentheses afterwards.
33482 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
33483 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
33484 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
33485 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
33486 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
33487 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
33489 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
33490 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
33492 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
33493 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
33496 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
33497 .cindex "discarded messages"
33498 .cindex "message" "discarded"
33499 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
33500 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
33501 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
33503 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
33504 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
33506 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
33507 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
33509 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
33510 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
33514 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
33515 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
33517 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
33518 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
33520 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
33521 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
33522 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
33524 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
33525 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
33527 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
33528 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
33529 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
33533 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
33534 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
33535 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
33536 following form is logged:
33538 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
33539 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
33541 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
33542 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
33544 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
33545 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
33546 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
33547 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
33548 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
33550 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
33551 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
33552 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
33553 flagged with &`**`&.
33557 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
33558 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
33559 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
33560 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
33561 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
33565 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
33568 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
33570 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
33571 at the end of its processing.
33576 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
33577 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
33578 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
33579 the following table:
33581 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id)
33582 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
33583 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
33584 &`CV `& certificate verification status
33585 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
33586 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
33587 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
33588 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
33589 &`H `& host name and IP address
33590 &`I `& local interface used
33591 &`id `& message id for incoming message
33592 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
33593 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
33594 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
33595 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
33596 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
33597 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
33598 &`S `& size of message
33599 &`ST `& shadow transport name
33600 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
33601 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
33602 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
33603 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
33607 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
33608 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
33609 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
33612 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
33613 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
33614 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
33615 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
33616 during the first delivery attempt.
33618 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
33619 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
33620 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
33622 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
33623 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
33624 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
33625 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
33626 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
33629 .cindex "error" "ignored"
33630 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
33633 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
33634 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
33636 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
33637 failed. The delivery was discarded.
33639 A delivery set up by a router configured with
33640 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
33641 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
33645 failed. The delivery was discarded.
33653 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
33654 .cindex "log" "selectors"
33655 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
33656 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
33657 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
33660 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
33662 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
33663 selection marked by asterisks:
33665 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
33666 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
33667 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
33668 &` arguments `& command line arguments
33669 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
33670 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
33671 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
33672 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
33673 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
33674 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
33675 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
33676 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
33677 &` incoming_interface `& incoming interface on <= lines
33678 &` incoming_port `& incoming port on <= lines
33679 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
33680 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
33681 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
33682 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
33683 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
33684 &` pid `& Exim process id
33685 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
33686 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
33687 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
33688 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
33689 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
33690 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
33691 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
33692 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
33693 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
33694 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
33695 &` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
33696 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
33697 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
33698 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
33699 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
33700 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
33701 &` tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
33702 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
33703 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
33704 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
33705 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
33707 &` all `& all of the above
33709 More details on each of these items follows:
33712 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
33713 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
33714 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
33715 this log selector is set.
33717 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
33718 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
33719 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
33720 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
33721 such users cannot access the log).
33723 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
33724 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
33725 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
33726 parentheses between them.
33728 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
33729 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
33730 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
33731 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
33732 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
33733 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
33734 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
33735 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
33736 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
33737 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
33738 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
33739 between the caller and Exim.
33741 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
33742 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
33743 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
33745 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
33746 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
33747 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
33748 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
33749 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
33750 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
33752 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
33753 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
33754 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
33756 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
33757 .cindex "size" "of message"
33758 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
33759 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
33761 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
33762 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
33763 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
33764 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
33765 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
33767 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
33768 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
33769 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
33770 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
33771 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
33772 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
33774 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
33775 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
33776 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
33777 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
33778 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
33780 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
33781 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
33782 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
33783 client's ident port times out.
33785 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
33786 .cindex "interface" "logging"
33787 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
33788 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
33789 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
33790 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, and to
33793 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
33794 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
33795 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
33796 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
33797 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
33798 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
33799 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
33800 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
33801 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
33802 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
33803 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
33805 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
33806 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
33807 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
33809 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
33810 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
33811 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
33812 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
33813 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
33814 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
33815 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
33817 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
33818 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
33819 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
33820 immediately after the time and date.
33822 .cindex "log" "queue run"
33823 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
33824 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
33826 .cindex "log" "queue time"
33827 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
33828 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
33829 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
33830 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
33831 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
33832 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
33833 message has been successfully received.
33835 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
33836 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
33837 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
33838 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
33840 .cindex "log" "recipients"
33841 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
33842 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
33843 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
33844 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
33846 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
33849 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
33850 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
33851 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
33852 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
33854 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
33855 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
33856 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
33857 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
33858 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
33860 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
33861 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
33862 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
33863 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
33866 .cindex "log" "return path"
33867 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
33868 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
33869 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
33870 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
33872 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
33873 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
33874 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
33875 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
33876 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
33878 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
33879 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
33880 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
33881 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
33884 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
33885 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
33888 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
33889 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
33890 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
33891 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
33893 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
33894 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
33896 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
33897 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
33898 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP dialogue for
33899 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
33900 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
33903 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
33904 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
33905 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
33906 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
33907 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
33908 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
33909 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
33910 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
33911 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
33912 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
33914 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
33915 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
33916 reset if the daemon is restarted.
33917 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
33918 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
33919 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
33920 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
33921 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
33923 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
33924 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
33925 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
33926 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
33927 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
33928 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
33930 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
33931 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
33932 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
33933 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
33934 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
33935 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
33936 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
33937 already have their own log lines.
33939 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
33940 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
33941 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
33942 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
33943 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
33944 the same logging options.
33946 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
33947 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
33951 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
33952 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
33953 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
33954 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
33955 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
33957 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
33958 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
33959 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
33960 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
33961 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
33962 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
33963 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
33964 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
33966 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
33967 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
33968 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
33969 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
33970 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
33971 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
33972 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
33973 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
33974 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
33976 .cindex "log" "subject"
33977 .cindex "subject, logging"
33978 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
33979 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
33980 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
33981 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
33982 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
33984 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
33985 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
33986 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
33987 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
33989 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
33990 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
33991 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
33992 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
33994 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
33995 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
33996 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
33997 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
33998 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
34000 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
34001 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
34002 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
34003 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
34004 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
34006 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
34007 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
34008 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
34012 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
34013 .cindex "message" "log file for"
34014 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
34015 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
34016 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
34017 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
34018 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
34019 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
34020 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
34021 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
34022 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
34023 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
34024 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
34026 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
34027 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
34028 &%message_logs%& option false.
34034 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34035 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34037 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
34038 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
34039 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
34040 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
34041 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
34043 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
34044 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
34045 "list what Exim processes are doing"
34046 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
34047 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
34048 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
34049 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
34051 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
34052 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
34053 "extract statistics from the log"
34054 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
34055 "check address acceptance from given IP"
34056 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
34057 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
34058 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
34059 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
34060 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
34061 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
34064 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
34065 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
34066 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
34071 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
34072 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
34073 .cindex "process, querying"
34075 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
34076 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
34077 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
34078 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
34079 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
34080 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
34081 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
34082 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
34084 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
34085 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
34086 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
34089 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
34090 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
34091 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
34092 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
34093 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
34096 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
34097 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
34098 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
34099 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
34101 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
34103 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
34104 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
34105 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
34106 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
34107 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
34108 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
34110 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
34111 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
34115 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
34116 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
34117 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
34118 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
34122 to obtain a queue listing with undelivered recipients only, and then greps the
34123 output to select messages that match given criteria. The following selection
34124 options are available:
34127 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
34128 Match the sender address. The field that is tested is enclosed in angle
34129 brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
34133 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
34134 Match a recipient address. The field that is tested is not enclosed in angle
34137 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
34138 Match against the size field.
34140 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
34141 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
34143 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
34144 Match messages that are older than the given time.
34147 Match only frozen messages.
34150 Match only non-frozen messages.
34153 The following options control the format of the output:
34157 Display only the count of matching messages.
34160 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
34164 Display message ids only.
34167 Brief format &-- one line per message.
34170 Display messages in reverse order.
34173 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
34177 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
34178 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
34179 .cindex "queue" "summary"
34180 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
34181 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
34182 running a command such as
34184 exim -bp | exiqsumm
34186 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
34187 it, as in the following example:
34189 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
34191 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
34192 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
34193 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
34194 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
34196 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
34197 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
34198 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
34199 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
34200 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
34201 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
34204 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
34205 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
34206 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
34207 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
34208 level"& addresses).
34213 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
34215 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
34216 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
34217 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
34218 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
34219 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
34220 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
34221 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
34222 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
34223 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
34224 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
34226 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
34228 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
34230 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
34231 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
34232 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
34234 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
34235 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
34236 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
34237 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
34238 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
34240 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
34241 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
34242 regular expression.
34244 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
34245 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
34247 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
34248 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
34249 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
34252 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
34253 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
34254 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
34255 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
34256 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
34257 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
34258 the &%--help%& option.
34261 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
34262 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
34263 .cindex "cycling logs"
34264 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
34265 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
34266 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
34267 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
34268 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
34269 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
34270 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
34272 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
34273 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
34275 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
34276 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
34277 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
34281 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
34282 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
34283 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
34284 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
34285 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
34286 logs are handled similarly.
34288 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
34289 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
34290 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
34291 any existing log files.
34293 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
34294 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
34295 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
34296 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
34297 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
34299 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
34301 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
34302 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
34306 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
34307 .cindex "statistics"
34308 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
34309 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
34310 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
34311 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
34312 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
34314 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
34315 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
34316 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
34317 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
34318 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
34320 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
34322 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
34323 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
34324 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
34325 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
34326 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
34327 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
34328 also produced per user.
34330 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
34331 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
34332 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
34333 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
34334 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
34336 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
34337 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
34338 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
34339 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
34340 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
34341 an entirely separate message.
34343 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
34344 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
34345 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
34346 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
34347 least one address that failed.
34349 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
34350 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
34351 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
34352 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
34353 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
34354 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
34355 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
34357 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
34358 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
34359 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
34361 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
34362 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
34363 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
34365 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
34368 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
34369 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
34370 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
34371 .cindex "checking access"
34372 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
34373 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
34374 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
34375 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
34376 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
34377 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
34379 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
34380 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
34382 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
34384 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
34385 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
34386 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
34387 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
34390 550 Relay not permitted
34392 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
34393 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
34394 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
34395 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
34398 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
34399 -f himself@there.example
34401 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
34402 mandatory arguments.
34404 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
34405 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
34406 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
34410 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
34411 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
34412 .cindex "building DBM files"
34413 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
34414 .cindex "lower casing"
34415 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
34416 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
34417 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
34418 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
34419 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
34420 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
34422 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
34423 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
34424 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
34425 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
34428 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
34429 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
34430 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
34434 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
34435 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
34436 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
34437 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
34439 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
34441 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
34442 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
34444 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
34445 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
34446 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
34447 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
34448 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
34449 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
34451 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
34452 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
34453 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
34454 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
34455 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
34456 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
34457 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
34463 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
34464 .cindex "retry" "times"
34465 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
34466 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
34467 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
34468 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
34469 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
34470 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
34471 output. For example:
34473 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
34474 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
34475 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
34476 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
34477 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
34478 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
34479 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
34480 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
34481 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
34482 past final cutoff time
34484 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
34485 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
34486 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
34487 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
34488 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
34489 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
34492 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
34493 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
34494 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
34495 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
34496 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
34497 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
34501 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
34502 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
34503 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
34504 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
34505 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
34506 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
34507 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
34510 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
34512 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
34515 &'callout'&: the callout cache
34517 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
34519 &'misc'&: other hints data
34522 The &'misc'& database is used for
34525 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
34527 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
34528 &(smtp)& transport)
34533 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
34534 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
34535 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
34536 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
34537 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
34539 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
34541 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
34543 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
34544 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
34546 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
34547 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
34548 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
34549 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
34550 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
34551 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
34552 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
34553 and a textual description of the error.
34555 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
34556 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
34557 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
34560 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
34561 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
34562 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
34563 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
34564 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
34565 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
34570 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
34571 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
34572 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
34573 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
34574 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
34575 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
34576 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
34577 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
34578 updated sufficiently often.
34580 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
34581 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
34582 the retry database:
34584 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
34586 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
34587 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
34588 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
34589 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
34590 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
34591 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
34592 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
34593 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
34594 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
34595 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
34596 whenever it removes information from the database.
34598 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
34599 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
34600 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
34601 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
34602 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
34604 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
34605 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
34606 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
34607 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
34608 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
34609 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
34610 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
34613 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
34614 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
34619 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
34620 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
34621 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
34622 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
34623 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
34624 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
34625 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
34628 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
34629 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
34630 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
34631 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
34632 by new data, for example:
34636 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
34637 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
34638 used as optional separators.
34643 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
34644 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
34645 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
34646 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
34647 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
34648 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
34649 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
34650 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
34651 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
34652 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
34653 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
34654 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
34655 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
34659 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
34662 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
34665 .vitem &%-interval%&
34666 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
34667 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
34669 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
34670 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
34673 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
34676 Suppress verification output.
34678 .vitem &%-retries%&
34679 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
34680 the lock (default 10).
34682 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
34683 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
34684 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
34685 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
34688 .vitem &%-timeout%&
34689 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
34690 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
34691 default), a non-blocking call is used.
34694 Generate verbose output.
34697 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
34698 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
34699 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
34700 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
34701 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
34702 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
34703 more than 30 minutes old.
34705 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
34706 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
34707 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
34708 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
34709 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
34710 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
34712 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
34713 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
34714 suppresses all output except error messages.
34718 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
34720 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
34722 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
34723 <&'some commands'&>
34726 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
34727 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
34730 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
34731 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
34733 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
34734 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
34738 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34741 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
34742 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
34743 .cindex "X-windows"
34744 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
34745 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
34746 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
34747 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
34748 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
34749 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
34750 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
34751 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
34755 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
34756 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
34757 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
34758 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
34759 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
34760 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
34761 parameters are for.
34763 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
34764 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
34765 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
34767 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
34769 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
34770 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
34771 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
34772 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
34773 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
34775 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
34776 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
34778 Eximon*background: gray94
34780 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
34781 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
34782 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
34783 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
34784 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
34785 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
34786 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
34789 Eximon*highlight: gray
34792 .cindex "admin user"
34793 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
34794 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
34796 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
34797 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
34798 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
34799 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
34800 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
34802 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
34803 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
34804 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
34805 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
34806 different parts of the display.
34811 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
34812 .cindex "stripchart"
34813 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
34814 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
34815 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
34816 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
34817 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
34818 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
34819 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
34820 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
34821 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
34823 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
34824 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
34825 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
34826 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
34828 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
34829 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
34830 to a single partition.
34832 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
34833 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
34834 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
34835 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
34836 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
34837 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
34838 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
34843 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
34844 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
34845 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
34846 .cindex "window size"
34847 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
34848 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
34849 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
34850 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
34851 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
34852 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
34854 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
34855 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
34856 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
34857 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
34859 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
34860 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
34861 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
34862 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
34863 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
34864 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
34866 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
34867 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
34868 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
34872 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
34873 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
34874 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
34875 the main log is maintained.
34876 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
34877 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
34878 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
34879 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
34880 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
34882 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
34883 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
34884 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
34885 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
34886 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
34887 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
34888 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
34889 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
34890 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
34891 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
34892 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
34894 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
34895 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
34896 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
34897 It cannot go further back up the log.
34899 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
34900 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
34901 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
34902 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
34903 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
34904 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
34906 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
34907 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
34908 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
34909 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
34910 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
34911 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
34913 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
34914 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
34915 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
34916 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
34917 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
34918 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
34919 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
34920 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
34921 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
34926 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
34927 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
34928 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
34929 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
34930 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
34931 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
34932 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
34933 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
34934 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
34935 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
34937 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
34938 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
34939 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
34940 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
34941 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
34942 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
34943 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
34945 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
34946 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
34947 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
34948 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
34949 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
34950 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
34951 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
34953 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
34954 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
34955 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
34956 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
34958 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
34959 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
34960 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
34961 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
34962 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
34963 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
34964 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
34967 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
34968 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
34970 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
34971 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
34972 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
34973 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
34974 display is updated.
34978 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
34979 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
34980 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
34981 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
34982 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
34985 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
34986 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
34987 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
34988 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
34989 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
34991 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
34993 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
34997 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
34998 in a new text window.
35000 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
35001 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
35002 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
35004 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
35005 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
35006 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
35007 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
35009 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
35010 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
35011 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
35012 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
35013 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
35015 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
35016 that the message be frozen.
35018 .cindex "thawing messages"
35019 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
35020 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
35021 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
35022 that the message be thawed.
35024 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
35025 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
35026 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
35027 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
35029 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
35030 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
35033 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
35034 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
35035 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
35036 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
35037 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
35038 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
35039 which case no action is taken.
35041 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
35042 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
35043 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
35044 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
35045 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
35046 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
35047 case no action is taken.
35049 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
35050 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
35052 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
35053 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
35054 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
35055 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
35056 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
35057 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
35058 the address is qualified with that domain.
35061 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
35062 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
35063 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
35064 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
35065 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
35066 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
35067 if no output is generated.
35069 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
35070 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
35071 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
35072 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
35074 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
35075 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
35076 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
35083 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35084 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35086 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
35087 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
35088 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
35089 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
35091 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
35092 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
35093 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
35094 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
35095 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
35096 its security as compared with other MTAs.
35098 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
35099 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
35100 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
35101 as soon as possible.
35104 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
35105 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
35106 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
35107 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
35108 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
35109 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
35112 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
35113 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
35114 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
35115 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
35116 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
35117 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
35119 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
35120 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
35121 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
35122 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
35125 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
35126 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
35127 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
35128 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
35129 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
35130 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
35131 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
35132 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
35133 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
35137 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
35138 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
35139 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
35140 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
35141 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
35142 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
35143 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
35145 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
35148 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
35149 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
35150 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
35151 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
35152 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
35157 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
35159 .cindex "root privilege"
35160 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
35161 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
35162 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
35163 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
35164 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
35165 is required for two things:
35168 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
35169 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
35172 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
35173 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
35177 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
35178 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
35179 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
35180 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
35181 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
35182 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
35183 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
35184 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
35186 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
35187 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
35188 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
35190 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
35191 uid and gid in the following cases:
35196 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
35197 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
35198 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
35199 the calling process.
35200 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
35201 option may not be used at all.
35202 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
35203 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
35204 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
35209 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
35210 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
35213 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
35214 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
35215 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
35216 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
35217 testing address verification
35220 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
35223 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
35224 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
35227 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
35230 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
35231 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
35232 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
35233 will be used during message reception.
35235 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
35236 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
35238 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
35239 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
35240 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
35241 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
35242 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
35243 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
35244 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
35245 generating bounce and warning messages.
35247 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
35248 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
35249 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
35250 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
35252 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
35253 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
35259 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
35260 .cindex "privilege, running without"
35261 .cindex "unprivileged running"
35262 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
35263 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
35264 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
35265 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
35266 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
35267 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
35268 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
35272 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
35273 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
35274 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
35275 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
35277 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
35278 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
35279 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
35280 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
35281 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
35283 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
35284 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
35285 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
35288 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
35289 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
35290 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
35292 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
35293 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
35294 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
35295 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
35296 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
35297 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
35298 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
35299 address this problem at this time.
35301 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
35302 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
35303 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
35304 be used in the most straightforward way.
35306 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
35307 number of restrictions on what you can do:
35310 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
35311 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
35312 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
35313 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
35314 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
35316 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
35317 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
35319 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
35320 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
35321 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
35322 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
35324 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
35325 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
35328 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
35329 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
35330 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
35332 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
35333 owned by the Exim user.
35335 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
35336 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
35337 mailboxes need to be created manually.
35342 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
35343 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
35344 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
35345 gives more security at essentially no cost.
35347 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
35348 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
35353 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
35354 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
35355 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
35359 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
35360 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
35361 .cindex "IP source routing"
35362 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
35363 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
35364 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
35365 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
35369 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
35370 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
35371 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
35376 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
35377 .cindex "trusted users"
35378 .cindex "admin user"
35379 .cindex "privileged user"
35380 .cindex "user" "trusted"
35381 .cindex "user" "admin"
35382 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
35383 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
35384 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
35385 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
35386 permit a remote host to be specified.
35389 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
35390 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
35391 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
35392 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
35393 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
35394 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
35396 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
35397 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
35398 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
35399 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
35400 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
35402 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
35403 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
35404 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
35405 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
35406 includes the contents of files on the spool.
35410 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
35411 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
35412 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
35413 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
35414 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
35415 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
35417 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
35418 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
35419 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
35420 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
35421 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
35422 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
35427 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
35428 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
35429 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
35430 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
35431 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
35432 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
35436 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
35437 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
35438 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
35439 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
35440 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
35445 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
35446 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
35447 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
35448 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
35453 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
35454 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
35455 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
35456 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
35457 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
35461 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
35462 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
35463 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
35467 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
35468 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
35469 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
35470 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
35471 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
35472 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
35473 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
35475 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
35476 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
35481 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
35482 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
35483 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
35484 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
35488 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
35489 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
35490 enough to hold the result.
35491 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
35496 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35497 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35499 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
35500 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
35501 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
35502 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
35503 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
35504 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
35505 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
35506 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
35507 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
35508 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
35509 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
35510 themselves are recoverable.
35512 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
35513 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
35514 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
35517 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
35518 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
35519 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
35520 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
35521 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
35523 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
35524 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
35525 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
35526 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
35527 will always be the case.
35529 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
35531 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
35534 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
35536 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
35537 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
35538 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
35539 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
35540 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
35541 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
35542 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
35543 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
35546 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
35547 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
35548 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
35549 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
35550 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
35551 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
35552 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
35553 normally the Exim user.
35555 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
35556 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
35557 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
35558 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
35559 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
35560 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
35561 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
35562 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
35564 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
35565 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
35566 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
35567 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
35569 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
35570 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
35573 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
35574 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
35575 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
35576 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
35577 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
35578 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
35579 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
35580 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
35581 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
35584 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
35585 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
35586 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
35587 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
35588 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
35589 character. It may contain internal newlines.
35591 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
35592 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
35593 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
35594 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
35595 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
35596 character. It may contain internal newlines.
35598 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
35599 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
35600 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
35602 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
35603 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
35604 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
35605 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
35606 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
35608 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
35609 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
35610 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
35611 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
35612 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
35614 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
35615 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
35616 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
35618 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
35619 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
35620 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
35622 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
35623 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
35626 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
35627 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
35628 present if the number is greater than zero.
35630 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
35631 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
35632 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
35634 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
35635 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
35636 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
35638 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
35639 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
35642 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
35643 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
35644 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
35647 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
35648 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
35649 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
35650 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
35652 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
35653 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
35654 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
35656 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
35657 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
35658 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
35659 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
35660 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
35661 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
35663 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
35664 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
35665 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
35666 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
35667 supplied by the remote host, if any.
35669 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
35670 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
35671 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
35672 generated messages.
35675 The message is from a local sender.
35677 .vitem &%-localerror%&
35678 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
35680 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
35681 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
35682 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
35683 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
35685 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
35686 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
35687 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
35690 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
35691 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
35694 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
35695 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
35696 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
35698 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
35699 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
35700 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
35702 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
35703 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
35704 of &$spam_score_int$&.
35706 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
35707 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
35708 certificate was verified by the server.
35710 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
35711 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
35712 name of the cipher suite that was used.
35714 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
35715 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
35716 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
35720 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
35721 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
35722 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
35723 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
35724 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
35725 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
35726 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
35727 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
35728 addresses are complete.
35730 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
35731 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
35732 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
35733 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
35734 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
35735 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
35737 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
35738 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
35739 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35741 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
35742 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
35743 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
35744 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
35748 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35749 darcy@austen.fict.example
35751 alice@wonderland.fict.example
35753 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
35754 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
35755 line is of the following form:
35757 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
35758 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
35760 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
35761 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
35762 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
35763 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
35764 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
35765 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
35766 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
35767 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
35770 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
35771 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
35772 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
35773 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
35774 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
35778 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
35779 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
35780 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
35781 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
35782 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
35783 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
35784 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
35785 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
35786 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
35787 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
35790 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
35791 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
35792 typical set of headers:
35794 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
35795 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
35796 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
35797 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
35798 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
35799 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
35800 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
35801 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35802 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
35803 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35804 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
35806 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
35807 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
35808 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
35809 .ecindex IIDforspo1
35810 .ecindex IIDforspo2
35811 .ecindex IIDforspo3
35813 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35814 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35816 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHID12" &&&
35820 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
35821 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
35822 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
35823 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
35825 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
35826 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
35828 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
35830 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
35831 It can co-exist with all other Exim features, including transport filters.
35833 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
35834 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
35835 different signature contexts.
35838 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
35839 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
35840 Exim's standard controls.
35842 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
35843 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
35844 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
35845 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
35847 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
35848 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
35849 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
35850 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
35852 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
35853 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
35854 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
35855 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
35859 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
35860 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
35862 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
35863 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
35865 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
35867 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
35868 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
35870 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
35872 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
35873 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
35874 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
35875 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
35877 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
35879 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
35880 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
35881 The result can either
35883 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
35885 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
35888 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
35889 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
35893 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
35895 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
35896 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
35897 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
35898 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
35900 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
35902 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
35903 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
35904 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
35905 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
35908 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
35910 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
35911 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
35912 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
35916 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
35917 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
35919 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
35920 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
35921 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
35923 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
35924 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
35925 runtime of the ACL.
35927 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
35928 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
35929 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
35930 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
35932 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
35933 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
35934 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
35935 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
35936 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
35937 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
35940 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
35942 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
35943 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
35944 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
35946 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
35948 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
35949 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
35950 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
35952 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
35955 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
35956 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
35959 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
35960 available (from most to least important):
35964 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
35965 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
35966 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
35967 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
35968 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
35969 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
35971 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
35972 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
35974 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
35975 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
35977 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
35978 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
35980 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
35982 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
35983 A string giving a litte bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
35984 "fail" or "invalid". One of
35986 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
35987 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
35989 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
35990 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
35992 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
35993 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
35994 means that the message body was modified in transit.
35996 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
35997 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
35998 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
35999 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
36001 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
36002 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
36003 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
36004 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
36005 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
36006 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
36007 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
36008 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
36009 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
36010 The key record selector string.
36011 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
36012 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
36013 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
36014 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
36015 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
36016 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
36017 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
36018 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
36019 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
36020 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
36021 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
36022 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
36023 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
36024 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
36025 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
36026 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
36027 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
36028 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
36029 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
36030 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
36031 integer size comparisons against this value.
36032 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
36033 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
36034 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
36035 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
36036 .vitem &%$nosubdomains%&
36037 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
36038 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
36039 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
36041 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
36042 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
36044 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
36045 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
36048 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
36051 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
36052 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
36053 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
36054 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
36055 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
36058 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
36059 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
36060 sender_domains = gmail.com
36061 dkim_signers = gmail.com
36065 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
36066 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
36067 results agains the actual result of verification. This is typically used
36068 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
36071 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
36072 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
36073 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
36074 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
36077 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
36078 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
36079 for more information of what they mean.
36082 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36083 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36085 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
36086 "Adding drivers or lookups"
36087 .cindex "adding drivers"
36088 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
36089 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
36090 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
36091 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
36094 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
36095 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
36097 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
36099 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
36101 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
36102 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
36103 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
36105 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
36107 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
36110 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
36111 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
36113 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
36114 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
36115 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
36117 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
36120 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
36121 as for other drivers and lookups.
36124 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
36125 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
36126 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
36127 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
36128 searched using a binary chop procedure.
36130 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
36131 the interface that is expected.
36136 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36137 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36139 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36140 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
36141 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
36142 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
36144 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36149 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
36150 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
36154 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
36155 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
36156 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
36159 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36160 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////